Sample & Buy Product Folder Support & Community Tools & Software Technical Documents LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 LMK03318 Ultra-Low-Noise Jitter Clock Generator Family with One PLL, Eight Outputs, Integrated EEPROM 1 Features • 1 • • • • – Industrial Temperature Range (–40ºC to 85ºC) Ultra-Low Noise, High Performance – Jitter: 100-fs RMS Typical, FOUT > 100 MHz – PSRR: –70 dBc, Robust Supply Noise Immunity Flexible Device Options – Up to 8 AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML, HCSL or LVCMOS Outputs or Any Combination – Pin Mode, I2C Mode, EEPROM Mode – 71-Pin Selectable Pre-programmed Default Start-up Options Dual Inputs with Automatic or Manual Selection – Crystal Input: 10 to 52 MHz – External Input: 1 to 300 MHz Frequency Margining Options – Fine frequency Margining Using Low-Cost Pullable Crystal Reference – Glitchless Coarse Frequency Margining (%) Using Output Dividers Other Features – Supply: 3.3 V Core, 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V Output Supply 2 Applications • • • • Switches and Routers Network and Telecom Line Cards Servers and Storage Systems Wireless Base Station 3 Description The LMK03318 is an ultra-low-noise PLLatinumTM clock generator with one fractional-N frequency synthesizer with integrated VCO, flexible clock distribution/fanout, and pin-selectable configuration states stored in on-chip EEPROM. The device can generate multiple clocks for various multi-gigabit serial interfaces and digital devices, thus reducing BOM cost and board area and improving reliability by replacing multiple oscillators and clock distribution devices. The ultra-low jitter reduces bit-error rate (BER) in high-speed serial links. Device Information(1) PART NUMBER LMK03318 PACKAGE WQFN (48) BODY SIZE (NOM) 7.00 mm × 7.00 mm (1) For all available packages, see the orderable addendum at the end of the data sheet. LMK03318 Simplified Block Diagram Power Conditioning Smart MUX 2 PLL Output Dividers LMK03318 8 Output Buffers 8 Interface I2C/ROM/ EEPROM Ultra-high performance clock generator 1 An IMPORTANT NOTICE at the end of this data sheet addresses availability, warranty, changes, use in safety-critical applications, intellectual property matters and other important disclaimers. PRODUCTION DATA. LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 4 Description Continued For the PLL, a differential/single-ended clock or crystal input can be selected as its reference clock. The selected reference input can be used to lock the VCO frequency at an integer or fractional multiple of the reference input frequency. The VCO frequency can be tuned between 4.8 GHz and 5.4 GHz. The PLL offers the flexibility to select a predefined or user-defined loop bandwidth, depending on the needs of the application. The PLL has a post-divider that can be selected between divide-by 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 or 8. All the output channels can select the divided-down VCO clock from the PLL as the source for the output divider to set the final output frequency. Some output channels can also independently select the reference input for the PLL as an alternative source to be bypassed to the corresponding output buffers. The 8-bit output dividers support a divide range of 1 to 256 (even or odd), output frequencies up to 1 GHz, and output phase synchronization capability. All output pairs are ground-referenced CML drivers with programmable swing that can be interfaced to LVDS, LVPECL or CML receivers with AC coupling. All output pairs can also be independently configured as HCSL outputs or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. The outputs offer lower power at 1.8 V, higher performance and power supply noise immunity, and lower EMI compared to voltage-referenced driver designs (such as traditional LVDS and LVPECL drivers). Two additional 3.3-V LVCMOS outputs can be obtained via the STATUS pins. This is an optional feature in case of a need for 3.3-V LVCMOS outputs and device status signals are not needed. The device features self start-up from on-chip programmable EEPROM or pre-defined ROM memory, which offers multiple custom device modes selectable via pin control eliminating the need for serial programming. The device registers and on-chip EEPROM settings are fully programmable via the I2C-compatible serial interface. The device slave address is programmable in EEPROM and LSBs can be set with a 3-state pin. The device provides two frequency margining options with glitch-free operation to support system design verification tests (DVT), such as standard compliance and system timing margin testing. Fine frequency margining (in ppm) can be supported by using a low-cost pullable crystal on the internal crystal oscillator (XO), and selecting this input as the reference to the PLL synthesizer. The frequency margining range is determined by the crystal’s trim sensitivity and the on-chip varactor range. XO frequency margining can be controlled through pin or I2C control for ease-of use and high flexibility. Coarse frequency margining (in %) is available on any output channel by changing the output divide value via I2C interface, which synchronously stops and restarts the output clock to prevent a glitch or runt pulse when the divider is changed. Internal power conditioning provide excellent power supply ripple rejection (PSRR), reducing the cost and complexity of the power delivery network. The analog and digital core blocks operate from 3.3 V ± 5% supply and output blocks operate from 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V ± 5% supply. 5 Device Comparison Table Table 1. LVPECL Output Jitter over Different Integration Bandwidths OUTPUT FREQUENCY (MHz) INTEGRATION BANDWIDTH TYPICAL JITTER (ps, rms) < 100 12 kHz - 5 MHz 0.15 > 100 1 kHz – 5 MHz 12 kHz – 20 MHz 0.1 6 Revision History Changes from Original (September 2015) to Revision A • 2 Page Product Preview to Production Data full release ................................................................................................................... 1 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 7 Pin Configuration and Functions OUT7_P OUT7_N VDDO_7 OUT6_P OUT6_N VDDO_6 OUT5_P OUT5_N VDDO_5 OUT4_P OUT4_N VDDO_4 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 RHS Package 48-Pin QFN Top View PRIREF_N 7 30 GPIO2 REFSEL 8 29 NC HW_SW_CTRL 9 28 CAP_LDO SECREF_P 10 27 VDD_LDO SECREF_N 11 26 SCL GPIO0 12 25 SDA 24 GPIO3 GPIO1 31 23 6 OUT3_P PRIREF_P 22 GPIO4 OUT3_N 32 21 5 OUT2_N VDD_IN 20 GPIO5 OUT2_P 33 19 4 VDDO_23 VDD_DIG 18 LF VDDO_01 34 17 3 OUT1_P CAP_DIG 16 CAP_PLL OUT1_N 35 15 2 OUT0_N STATUS1 14 VDD_PLL OUT0_P 36 13 1 PDN STATUS0 Pin Functions NO. NAME TYPE DESCRIPTION DAP Ground Die Attach Pad. The DAP is an electrical connection and provides a thermal dissipation path. For proper electrical and thermal performance of the device, a 6 × 6 via pattern (0.3 mm holes) is recommended to connect the DAP to multiple ground layers of the PCB. Refer to Layout Guidelines. 4 VDD_DIG Analog 3.3 V power supply for digital control and STATUS outputs. 5 VDD_IN Analog 3.3 V power supply for input block. 18 VDDO_01 Analog 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V power supply for OUT0/OUT1 channel. 19 VDDO_23 Analog 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V power supply for OUT2/OUT3 channel. 27 VDD_LDO Analog 3.3 V power supply for PLL LDO. 36 VDD_PLL Analog 3.3 V power supply for PLL/VCO. 37 VDDO_4 Analog 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V power supply for OUT4 channel. 40 VDDO_5 Analog 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V power supply for OUT5 channel. 43 VDDO_6 Analog 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V power supply for OUT6 channel. 46 VDDO_7 Analog 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V power supply for OUT7 channel. POWER n/a Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 3 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Pin Functions (continued) NO. NAME TYPE DESCRIPTION PRIREF_P, PRIREF_N Universal Primary reference clock. Accepts a differential or single-ended input. Input pins have AC-coupling capacitors and biasing internally. For LVCMOS input, the non-driven input pin must be pulled down to ground. 8 REFSEL LVCMOS Manual reference input selection for PLL (3-state). Weak pullup resistor. 9 HW_SW_CTRL LVCMOS Selection for Hard Pin Mode (ROM), Soft Pin Mode (EEPROM), or Register Default Mode. Weak pullup resistor. SECREF_P, SECREF_N Universal Secondary reference clock. Accepts a differential or single-ended input or crystal input. Input pins have AC-coupling capacitors and biasing internally. For LVCMOS input, external input termination is needed to attenuate the swing to less than 2.6 V, and the non-driven input pin must be pulled down to ground. For crystal input, AT-cut fundamental crystal must be used as per defined specification, and pullable crystal should be used for fine margining. INPUT BLOCK 6, 7 10, 11 SYNTHESIZER BLOCK 3 CAP_DIG Analog External bypass capacitor for digital blocks. Attach a 10 µF to GND. 28 CAP_LDO Analog External bypass capacitor for PLL LDO. Attach a 10 µF to GND. 34 LF Analog External loop filter for PLL. 35 CAP_PLL Analog External bypass capacitor for PLL. Attach a 10 µF to GND. 14, 15 OUT0_P, OUT0_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 0. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 17, 16 OUT1_P, OUT1_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 1. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 20, 21 OUT2_P, OUT2_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 2. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 23, 22 OUT3_P, OUT3_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 3. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 39, 38 OUT4_P, OUT4_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 4. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 42, 41 OUT5_P, OUT5_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 5. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 45, 44 OUT6_P, OUT6_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 6. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. 48, 47 OUT7_P, OUT7_N Universal Differential/LVCMOS Output Pair 7. Programmable driver with differential or 2 × 1.8-V LVCMOS outputs. OUTPUT BLOCK 4 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Pin Functions (continued) NO. NAME TYPE DESCRIPTION DIGITAL CONTROL / INTERFACES (1) 1 STATUS0 Universal Status Output 0 (open drain, requires external pullup) or 3.3-V LVCMOS output from synth (push-pull). Status signal selection and output polarity are programmable. 2 STATUS1 Universal Status Output 1 (open drain, requires external pullup) or 3.3-V LVCMOS output from synth (push-pull). Status signal selection and output polarity are programmable. 12 GPIO0 LVCMOS Multifunction Inputs (2-state). 13 PDN LVCMOS Device Power-down (active low). Weak pullup resistor. 24 GPIO1 LVCMOS Multifunction Input (3-state or 2-state). 25 SDA LVCMOS I2C Serial Data (bi-directional, open drain). Requires an external pullup resistor to VDD_DIG. I2C slave address is initialized from on-chip EEPROM. 26 SCL LVCMOS I2C Serial Clock (bi-directional, open drain). Requires an external pull-up resistor to VDD_DIG. 29 NC N/A 30 GPIO2 LVCMOS Multifunction Input (3-state or 2-state). 31 GPIO3 LVCMOS Multifunction Input (3-state or 2-state). 32 GPIO4 LVCMOS Multifunction Input (2-state). 33 GPIO5 Universal Multifunction Input (2-state) or Analog input for frequency margin. (1) No Connect. Refer to Device Configuration Control for details on the digital control/interfaces. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 5 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 8 Specifications 8.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) (1) MIN MAX UNIT Supply voltage for input, synthesizer, control, and output blocks, VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG, VDDO_x –0.3 3.6 V Input voltage range, clock and logic inputs, VIN –0.3 VDD +0.3 V Output voltage range for clock and logic outputs, VOUT –0.3 VDD + 0.3 V 150 °C 150 °C Junction temperature, TJ Storage temperature, Tstg (1) –65 Stresses beyond those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, which do not imply functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under Recommended Operating Conditions. Exposure to absolute mAximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. 8.2 ESD Ratings VALUE V(ESD) (1) (2) Electrostatic discharge Human-body model (HBM), per ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001 (1) ± 2000 Charged-device model (CDM), per JEDEC specification JESD22-C101 (2) ± 500 UNIT V JEDEC document JEP155 states that 500 V HBM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. JEDEC document JEP157 states that 250 V CDM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. 8.3 Recommended Operating Conditions over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) Supply voltage for input, analog, control blocks, VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG MIN NOM MAX UNIT 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 3.465 V 85 °C 1.8 Supply voltage for output drivers (Differential, LVCMOS), VDDO_x 1.7 2.5 3.3 Ambient temperature, TA -40 25 Junction temperature, TJ Maximum VDD power-up ramp, dVDD/dt 0.1 EEPROM number of writes, WR 125 °C 100 ms 100 8.4 Thermal Information LMK03318 (2) (3) (4) RHA THERMAL METRIC (1) UNIT QFN-48 Airflow (LFM) 0 Airflow (LFM) 200 Airflow (LFM) 400 26.47 16.4 14.62 RθJC(top) Junction-to-case (top) thermal resistance 16.57 n/a n/a RθJB Junction-to-board thermal resistance 6.84 n/a n/a ψJT Junction-to-top characterization parameter 0.23 0.31 0.47 ψJB Junction-to-board characterization parameter 4.02 3.86 3.84 RθJC(bot) Junction-to-case (bottom) thermal resistance 1.06 n/a n/a RθJA (1) (2) (3) (4) 6 Junction-to-ambient thermal resistance °C/W For more information about traditional and new thermal metrics, see the Semiconductor and IC Package Thermal Metrics application report, SPRA953. The package thermal resistance is calculated on a 4 layer JEDEC board. Package DAP connected to PCB GND plane with 16 thermal vias (0.3 mm diameter). ψJB (junction to board) is used when the main heat flow is from the junction to the GND pad. Please refer to Thermal Considerations section for more information on ensuring good system reliability and quality. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 8.5 Thermal Information THERMAL METRIC LMK0331 8 (1) CONDITION UNIT RHA QFN-48 RθJA Junction-to-ambient thermal resistance 10-layer 200 mm x 250 mm board, 36 thermal vias, Airflow = 0 LFM 10 °C/W ψJB Junction-to-board characterization parameter 10-layer 200 mm x 250 mm board, 36 thermal vias, Airflow = 0 LFM 2.8 °C/W (1) For more information about traditional and new thermal metrics, see the Semiconductor and IC Package Thermal Metrics application report, SPRA953. 8.6 Electrical Characteristics - Power Supply VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C (1) (2) PARAMETER Core current consumption, per block lDD TEST CONDITIONS Output current consumption, per block IDD_IN IDD_PLL IDD_LDO IDD_DIG IDDO_01 IDDO_23 IDDO_4 IDDO_5 Current consumption, per supply pin IDDO_6 IDDO_7 IDD-PD (1) (2) Total device, LMK03318 TYP Primary input (differential or single ended) - active 10 Secondary input (differential or single ended) - active 10 Secondary input (XO) - active 11 PLL doubler - active PLL block – active IDDO MIN 110 53 Output channel (MUX and Divider only) – active 46 AC-LVDS driver (one pair) AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential 10 AC-LVPECL driver (one pair), AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential 18 AC-CML driver (one pair), AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential 16 HCSL driver (one pair) 50 Ω to GND 25 1.8-V LVCMOS driver (two outputs), 100 MHz, 5-pF load (2) 10 3.3-V LVCMOS driver on STATUS0, STATUS1, 100 MHz, 5-pF load (2) 21 Power down (PDN = 0) UNIT mA 4 Control block Inputs: - PRI input enabled, set to LVDS mode - SEC input enabled, set to crystal mode - Input MUX set to auto select - Reference clock is 25 MHz - R dividers set to 1 PLL: - M divider = 1 - Doubler enabled - ICP = 6.4 mA - Loop bandwidth = 400 kHz - VCO Frequency = 5 GHz - Feedback divider = 100 - Post divider = 8 Outputs: - OUT[0-7] = 156.25 MHz LVPECL - STATUS1: Loss of lock PLL - STATUS0: Loss of secondary reference Power Supplies: - VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V - VDDO_xx = 3.3 V MAX mA 48 65 mA 128 158 mA 15 30 mA 19 38 mA 85 105 mA 85 105 mA 58 75 mA 58 75 mA 58 75 mA 58 75 mA 30 50 mA Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. PTOTAL = PDC + PAC, where: PDC = 3.4 mA typical. PAC = C × V2 × fOUT. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 7 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 8.7 Pullable Crystal Characteristics (SECREF_P, SECREF_N) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C (1) (2) (3) (4) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MAX UNIT 52 MHz fXTAL = 10 MHz to 16 MHz 60 Ω fXTAL = 16 MHz to 30 MHz 50 fXTAL Crystal frequency Fundamental Mode ESR Equivalent series resistance MIN TYP 10 fXTAL = 30 MHz to 52 MHz 30 CL Load capacitance C0 Shunt capacitance 2.1 C0/C1 Shunt capacitance to motional capacitance ratio 220 PXTAL Crystal maximum drive level CXO On-Chip XO input capacitance at SECREF_P and SECREF_N Single-ended, each pin referenced to GND Trim Trim sensitivity CL = 9 pF, fXTAL = 50 MHz 25 CL = 9 pF, fXTAL = 25 MHz 35 Con-chip-5p- Recommended Crystal specifications 9 14 pF pF 250 300 uW 24 pF ppm/pF On-chip tunable capacitor variation over VT across crystal load of 5 pF Frequency accuracy of crystal over temperature, aging and initial accuracy < ± 25 ppm. 450 fF On-chip tunable capacitor variation over VT across crystal load of 12 pF Frequency accuracy of crystal over temperature, aging and initial accuracy < ± 25 ppm. 1.5 pF load fPR Pulling range Crystal C0/C1 < 250 load Con-chip-12p- (1) (2) (3) (4) 8 ± 50 ppm Parameter is specified by characterization and is not tested in production. The crystal pullability ratio is considered in the case where the XO frequency margining option is enabled. The actual pull range depends on the crystal pullability, as well as on-chip capacitance (Con-chip), device crystal oscillator input capacitance (CXO), PCB stray capacitance (CPCB), and any installed on-board tuning capacitance (CTUNE). Trim sensitivity or pullability (ppm/pF), TS = C1 × 1e6 / [2 × (C0 + CL)2]. If the total external capacitance is less than the crystal CL, the crystal oscillates at a higher frequency than the nominal crystal frequency. If the total external capacitance is higher than CL, the crystal oscillates at a lower frequency than nominal. Using a crystal with higher ESR can degrade output phase noise and may impact crystal start-up. Verified with crystals specified for a load capacitance of CL = 9 pF. PCB stray capacitance was measured to be 1 pF. Crystals tested: 19.2 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M19272001), 19.44 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M19472001), 25 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M25072001), 38.88 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M38872001), 49.152 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M49172001), 50 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M50072001). Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 8.8 Non-Pullable Crystal Characteristics (SECREF_P, SECREF_N) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C (1) (2) (3) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MAX UNIT 52 MHz fXTAL = 10 MHz to 16 MHz 60 Ω fXTAL = 16 MHz to 30 MHz 50 fXTAL Crystal frequency Fundamental mode ESR Equivalent series resistance MIN TYP 10 fXTAL = 30 MHz to 52 MHz PXTAL Crystal maximum drive level CXO On-Chip XO input capacitance Single-ended, each pin referenced to at Xi and Xo GND Con-chip-5p-load On-chip tunable capacitor variation over VT across crystal load of 5 pF Con-chip-12p-load On-chip tunable capacitor variation over VT across crystal load of 12 pF (1) (2) (3) 30 300 uW 24 pF Frequency accuracy of crystal over temperature, aging and initial accuracy < ± 25 ppm. 450 fF Frequency accuracy of crystal over temperature, aging and initial accuracy < ± 25 ppm. 1.5 pF 14 Parameter is specified by characterization and is not tested in production. Using a crystal with higher ESR can degrade XO phase noise and may impact crystal start-up. Verified with crystals specified for a load capacitance of CL = 9 pF. PCB stray capacitance was measured to be 1 pF. Crystal tested: 25 MHz TXC (part number: 7M25072001). 8.9 Clock Input Characteristics (PRIREF_P/PRIREF_N, SECREF_P/SECREF_N) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to 85°C (1) PARAMETER fCLK TEST CONDITIONS MIN Input frequency range MAX UNIT 1 TYP 300 MHz (2) LVCMOS input high voltage PRI_REF 1.4 VDD_IN V VIH (2) LVCMOS input high voltage SEC_REF 1.4 2.6 V VIL (2) LVCMOS input low voltage 0 0.5 V VID,DIFF,PP Input voltage swing, differential peak-peak Differential input (where VCLK – VnCLK = |VID| × 2) 0.2 2 V VICM Input common mode voltage Differential input 0.1 2 dV/dt (3) Input edge slew rate (20% to 80%) Differential input, peak-peak 0.5 IDC (3) Input clock duty cycle IIN Input leakage current CIN Input capacitance VIH (1) (2) (3) Single-ended input, non-driven input tied to GND V V/ns 0.5 V/ns 40% 60% –100 100 Single-ended, each pin µA 2 pF Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. Slew-rate-detect circuitry must be used when VIH > 1.7 V and VIL < 0.2 V. VIH/VIL detect circuitry must be used when VIH > 1.5 V and VIL < 0.4 V. Refer to REFDETCTL Register; R25 for relevant register information. Ensured by characterization. 8.10 VCO Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C PARAMETER fVCO Frequency range KVCO VCO Gain TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP 4.8 MAX 5.4 55 UNIT GHz MHz/V Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 9 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 8.11 PLL Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C PARAMETER fPD TEST CONDITIONS TYP 1 (1) PN1Hz PLL figure of merit PN10kHz PLL 1/f noise at 10 kHz offset ICP = 6.4 mA, 25 MHz phase detector normalized to 1 GHz (2) ICP-HIZ Charge-pump leakage in Hi-Z Mode (1) (2) MIN Phase detector frequency MAX UNIT 150 MHz –231 dBc/Hz –136 dBc/Hz 55 nA PLL flat phase noise = PN1 Hz + 20 × log(N) + 10 × log(fPD), with wide loop bandwidth and away from1/f noise region. Phase noise normalized to 1 GHz. PLL 1/f phase noise = PN10 kHz + 20 × log(FOUT/1 GHz) – 10 × log(offset/10 kHz) 8.12 1.8-V LVCMOS Output Characteristics (OUT[7:0]) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C, outputs loaded with 2 pF to GND (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP UNIT 200 MHz fOUT Output frequency VOH (2) Output high voltage IOH = 1 mA VOL Output low voltage IOL = 1 mA IOH Output high current 21 mA IOL Output low current –21 mA tR/tF Output rise/fall time 20% to 80% 250 ps (3) Output-to-output skew same divide value 100 ps tSKEW (3) Output-to-output skew LVCMOS-to-differential; same divide value 1.5 ns tSKEW 1 MAX tPROP-CMOS IN-to-OUT propagation delay PLL Bypass PN-Floor Output phase noise floor (fOFFSET > 10 MHz) 66.66 MHz ODC (3) Output Duty Cycle ROUT Output Impedance (1) (2) (3) 1.35 V 0.35 V 1 ns –155 45% dBc/Hz 55% Ω 50 Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. VOH level is NOT rail-to-rail for VDDO = 2.5 V or 3.3 V, 1.8-V LVCMOS output buffer supply is internally regulated down to 1.8 V. Ensured by characterization. 8.13 LVCMOS Output Characteristics (STATUS[1:0] VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDD_O = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to 85°C, outputs loaded with 2 pF to GND (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP UNIT 200 MHz fOUT Output frequency VOH Output high voltage IOH = 1 mA VOL Output low voltage IOL = 1 mA IOH Output high current 33 mA IOL Output low current -33 mA tR/tF (2) Output rise/fall time 2.1 ns PN-Floor Output phase noise floor (fOFFSET > 10 MHz) ODC (2) Output duty cycle ROUT Output impedance (1) (2) 10 3.75 MAX 2.5 V 0.6 20% to 80%, R49[3-2], R49[1:0] = 10 V 20% to 80%, R49[3-2], R49[1-0] = 00 0.35 ns 66.66 MHz -148 dBc/Hz 45% 55% 50 Ω Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. Ensured by characterization. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 8.14 Open-Drain Output Characteristics (STATUS[1:0]) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = -40°C to 85°C PARAMETER VOL TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP Output low voltage MAX UNIT 0.6 V 8.15 AC-LVPECL Output Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = -40°C to 85°C, output pair AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential load (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS fOUT Output frequency (2) VOD Output voltage swing VOUT-PP Differential output peak-topeak swing VOS Output common mode tSKEW (3) Output-to-output skew MIN TYP 1 500 800 300 LVPECL-to-LVPECL; same divide value IN-to-OUT propagation delay PLL Bypass 400 tR/tF (3) Output rise or fall time 175 20% to 80%, < 300 MHz ±100 mV around center point, > 300 MHz Output phase noise floor (fOFFSET > 10 MHz) ODC (3) Output duty cycle (1) (2) (3) UNIT 1000 MHz 1000 mV 2 × |VOD| tPROP-DIFF PN-Floor MAX 156.25 MHz V 700 mV 60 ps ps 300 ps 200 ps –164 45% dBc/Hz 55% Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. An output frequency over fOUT maximum specification is possible, but output swing may be less than VOD min spec. Ensured by characterization. 8.16 AC-LVDS Output Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = -40°C to 85°C, output pair AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential load (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS (2) MIN TYP fOUT Output frequency VOD Output voltage swing VOUT-PP Differential output peak-topeak swing VOS Output common mode tSKEW (2) Output-to-output skew tPROP-DIFF IN-to-OUT propagation delay PLL Bypass 400 Output rise/fall time 200 tR/tF (3) 1 250 400 Output phase noise floor (fOFFSET > 10 MHz) ODC (3) Output duty cycle (1) (2) (3) UNIT 800 MHz 450 mV 2 x |VOD| 100 LVDS-to-LVDS; same divide value 20% to 80%, < 300 MHz ±100 mV around center point, > 300 MHz PN-Floor MAX V 350 mV 60 ps ps 300 ps 200 156.25 MHz –160 45% ps dBc/Hz 55% Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. An output frequency over fOUT maximum specification is possible, but output swing may be less than VOD min spec. Ensured by characterization. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 11 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 8.17 AC-CML Output Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C, output pair AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential load (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS fOUT Output frequency (2) VOD Output voltage swing VSS Differential output peak-topeak swing VOS tSKEW tPROP- TYP 1 400 600 MAX UNIT 1000 MHz 1000 mV 2 × |VOD| Output common mode (3) MIN 150 Output-to-output skew CML-to-CML; same divide value IN-to-OUT propagation delay PLL Bypass 400 Output rise/fall time 20% to 80%, < 300 MHz 190 V 550 mV 60 ps ps DIFF tR/tF (3) ±100 mV around center point, > 300 MHz PN-Floor Output phase noise floor (fOFFSET > 10 MHz) ODC (3) Output duty cycle (1) (2) (3) 300 ps 200 156.25 MHz –160 45% ps dBc/Hz 55% Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. An output frequency over fOUT maximum specification is possible, but output swing may be less than VOD min spec. Ensured by characterization. 8.18 HCSL Output Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG= 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C, outputs with 50 Ω || 2 pF to GND (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS fOUT Output frequency VOH Output high voltage (2) (2) VOL Output low voltage VCROSS Absolute crossing voltage (3) VCROSS- Variation of VCROSS (3) MIN MAX UNIT 1 TYP 400 MHz 660 850 mV –150 150 mV 250 550 mV 0 140 mV 100 ps DELTA tSKEW (4) Output-to-output skew same divide value tPROP-DIFF IN-to-OUT propagation delay PLL Bypass dV/dt (4) Slew rate (2) PN-Floor Output phase noise floor (fOFFSET > 10 MHz) ODC (4) Output duty cycle (1) (2) (3) (4) 400 2.25 100 MHz ps 5 –158 45% V/ns dBc/Hz 55% Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. Measured from -150 mV to +150 mV on the differential waveform (OUT minus nOUT) with the 300 mVpp measurement window centered on the differential zero crossing. Ensured by design. Ensured by characterization. 8.19 Power-On/Reset Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C PARAMETER VTHRESH Threshold voltage VDROOP Allowable voltage droop tS-XTAL Start-up time with 25 MHz XTAL tS-CLK Start-up time with 25 MHz clock input 12 TEST CONDITIONS MIN MAX UNIT 2.95 V 0.1 V Measured from time of supply reaching 3.135 V to time of output frequency accurate to ±300 ppm 10 ms Measured from time of supply reaching 3.135 V to time of output frequency accurate to ±300 ppm 10 ms 2.72 Submit Documentation Feedback TYP Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 8.20 2-Level Logic Input Characteristics (HW_SW_CTRL, PDN, GPIO[5:0]) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN VIH Input high voltage VIL Input low voltage IIH Input high current VIH = VDD_DIG –40 IIL Input low current VIL = GND –40 CIN Input capacitance TYP MAX 1.2 UNIT V 0.6 V 40 µA 40 µA 2 pF 8.21 3-Level Logic Input Characteristics (REFSEL, GPIO[3:1]) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX 1.4 UNIT VIH Input high voltage VIM Input mid voltage V VIL Input low voltage 0.4 V IIH Input high current VIH = VDD_DIG –40 40 µA IIL Input low current VIL = GND –40 40 µA CIN Input capacitance 0.9 V 2 pF 8.22 Analog Input Characteristics (GPIO[5]) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C, pulldown resistor on GPIO[5] to GND as specified below, HW_SW_CTRL = 0 PARAMETER VCTRL Control voltage range VSTEP Input voltage for XO frequency offset step selection on GPIO[5] tDELAY TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP 0 MAX VDD_DIG UNIT V 50 Ω to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R88 and R89 50 mV 2.32 kΩ to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R90 and R91 200 mV 5.62 kΩ to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R92 and R93 400 mV 10.5 kΩ to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R94 and R95 600 mV 18.7 kΩ to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R96 and R97 800 mV 34.8 kΩ to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R98 and R99 1000 mV 84.5 kΩ to GND: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R100 and R101 1200 mV Left floating: Selects on-chip capacitive load set by R102 and R103 1400 mV 100 ms Delay between voltage changes on GPIO[5] pin Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 13 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 8.23 I2C-Compatible Interface Characteristics (SDA, SCL) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = –40°C to +85°C (1) (2) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX Input high voltage VIL Input low voltage IIH Input leakage CIN Input capacitance COUT Input capacitance VOL Output low voltage fSCL I2C clock rate tSU_STA START condition setup time SCL high before SDA low 0.6 µs tH_STA START condition hold time SCL low after SDA low 0.6 µs tPH_STA SCL pulse width high 0.6 µs tPL_STA SCL pulse width low 1.3 µs tSU_SDA SDA hold time tH_SDA SDA setup time tR_IN / tF_IN SCL/SDA input rise and fall time tF_OUT SDA output fall time tSU_STOP STOP condition setup time 0.6 µs tBUS Bus free time between STOP and START 1.3 µs (1) (2) 1.2 UNIT VIH V -40 0.6 V 40 µA 2 pF 400 IOL = 3 mA 100 SDA valid after SCL low pF 0.6 V 400 kHz 0 0.9 115 µs ns CBUS = 10 pF to 400 pF 300 ns 250 ns Total capacitive load for each bus line ≤ 400 pF. Ensured by design. 8.24 Typical 156.25 MHz Closed-Loop Output Phase Noise Characteristics VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V, VDDO_x = 1.8 V, 2.5 V, 3.3 V, TA = 25°C, Reference Input = 50 MHz, PFD = 100 MHz, Integer-N PLL bandwidth = 400 kHz, VCO frequency = 5 GHz, post divider = 8, output divider = 4, Output Type = AC-LVPECL/AC-LVDS/AC-CML/HCSL/LVCMOS (1) (2) OUTPUT TYPE PARAMETER AC-LVPECL AC-LVDS AC-CML HCSL LVCMOS UNIT phn10k Phase noise at 10 kHz offset –143 –142 –142 –141 –139 dBc/Hz phn50k Phase noise at 50 kHz offset –143.5 –143 –143 –142 –141 dBc/Hz phn100k Phase noise at 100 kHz offset –144 –144 –144 –144 –143 dBc/Hz phn500k Phase noise at 500 kHz offset –146 –146 –146 –146 –145 dBc/Hz phn1M Phase noise at 1 MHz offset –149.5 –149 –149 –149 –149 dBc/Hz phn5M Phase noise at 5 MHz offset –160.5 –160 –160 –159 –158 dBc/Hz phn20M Phase noise at 20 MHz offset –164.5 –164 –164 –161 –159 dBc/Hz RJ Random jitter integrated from 10 kHz to 20 MHz offsets 96 99 99 107 119 fs, RMS (1) (2) 14 Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. Jitter specifications apply for differential output formats with low-jitter differential input clock or crystal input. Phase jitter measured with Agilent E5052 signal source analyzer using a differential-to-single ended converter (balun or buffer). Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 8.25 Typical 161.1328125 MHz Closed-Loop Output Phase Noise Characteristics (1) (2) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V, VDDO_x = 1.8 V, 2.5 V, 3.3 V, TA = 25°C, Reference Input = 50 MHz, PFD = 100 MHz, Fractional-N PLL bandwidth = 400 kHz, VCO Frequency = 5.15625 GHz, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4, Output Type = AC-LVPECL/AC-LVDS/AC-CML/HCSL/LVCMOS OUTPUT TYPE PARAMETER AC-LVPECL AC-LVDS AC-CML HCSL LVCMOS UNIT phn10k Phase noise at 10 kHz offset –136 –136 –136 -135 -135 dBc/Hz phn50k Phase noise at 50 kHz offset –139 –139 –139 -139 -139 dBc/Hz phn100k Phase noise at 100 kHz offset –140 –140 –140 -140 -140 dBc/Hz phn500k Phase noise at 500 kHz offset –142 –142 –142 –142 -142 dBc/Hz phn1M Phase noise at 1 MHz offset –150 –150 –150 –149 -149 dBc/Hz phn5M Phase noise at 5 MHz offset –160.5 –160 –160 –159 -158 dBc/Hz phn20M Phase noise at 20 MHz offset –164.5 –164 –164 –161 -159 dBc/Hz RJ Random jitter integrated from 10 kHz to 20 MHz offsets 120 122 122 130 136 fs, RMS (1) (2) Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. Jitter specifications apply for differential output formats with low-jitter differential input clock or crystal input. Phase jitter measured with Agilent E5052 signal source analyzer using a differential-to-single ended converter (balun or buffer). 8.26 Closed-Loop Output Jitter Characteristics (1) (2) (3) (4) = 3.3 V ± 5%, VDDO_x = 1.8 V ± 5%, 2.5 V ± 5%, 3.3 V ± 5%, TA = -40°C to 85°C, Integer-N PLL with 4.8 GHz, 4.9152 GHz, 4.97664 GHz, 5 GHz or 5.1 GHz VCO, 400 kHz PLL bandwidth and doubler enabled or disabled, fractional-N PLL with 4.8 GHz, 4.9152 GHz, 4.944 GHz, 4.97664 GHz, 5 GHz, 5.15 GHz or 5.15625 GHz VCO, 400 kHz bandwidth and doubler enabled or disabled, 1.8-V or 3.3-V LVCMOS output load of 2 pF to GND, AC-LVPECL/AC-LVDS/CML output pair ACcoupled to 100 Ω differential load, HCSL outputs with 50 Ω || 2 pF to GND. TYP MAX UNIT RJ RMS Phase Jitter (12 kHz – 20 MHz) (1 kHz – 5 MHz) PARAMETER 19.2 MHz, 19.44 MHz, 25 MHz, 27 MHz, 38.88 MHz crystal, integer-N PLL, fOUT ≥ 100 MHz, all differential output types 120 200 fs RMS RJ RMS Phase Jitter (12 kHz – 20 MHz) (1 kHz – 5 MHz) 19.2 MHz, 19.44 MHz, 25 MHz, 27 MHz, 38.8- MHz crystal, fractional-N PLL, fOUT ≥ 100 MHz, all differential output types 200 350 fs RMS RJ RMS Phase Jitter (12 kHz – 20 MHz) (1 kHz – 5 MHz) 50 MHz crystal, Integer-N PLL, fOUT ≥ 100 MHz, all differential output types 100 200 fs RMS RJ RMS Phase Jitter (12 kHz – 20 MHz) (1 kHz – 5 MHz) 50 MHz crystal, integer-N PLL or PLL2, fractional-N PLL, fOUT ≥ 100 MHz, all differential output types 180 350 fs RMS RJ RMS Phase Jitter (12 kHz – 20 MHz) or (12 kHz – 5 MHz) fOUT ≥ 10 MHz, 1.8-V or 3.3-V LVCMOS output, integer-N or fractional-N PLL 800 fs RMS (1) (2) (3) (4) TEST CONDITIONS MIN Phase jitter measured with Agilent E5052 source signal analyzer using a differential-to-single-ended converter (balun or buffer) for differential outputs. Verified with crystals specified for a load capacitance of CL = 9 pF. PCB stray capacitance was measured to be 1 pF. Crystals tested: 19.2 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M19272001), 19.44 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M19472001), 25 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M25072001), 27 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M27072001), 38.88 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M38872001), 50 MHz TXC (Part Number: 7M50072001). Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. For output frequency < 40 MHz, integration band for RMS phase jitter is 12 kHz – 5 MHz. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 15 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 8.27 Typical Power Supply Noise Rejection Characteristics (1) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3 V, VDDO_x = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C, Reference Input = 50 MHz, PFD = 100 MHz, PLL bandwidth = 400 kHz, VCO Ffrequency = 5 GHz, post divider = 8, output divider = 4, AC-LVPECL/AC-LVDS/CML output pair AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential load, HCSL outputs with 50 Ω || 2 pF to GND, sinusoidal noise injected in either of the following supply nodes: VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_DIG or VDDO_x. 50-mV RIPPLE ON SUPPLY TYPE PARAMETER VDD_IN VDD_PLL VDD_LDO VDD_DIG VDDO_x UNIT PSNR50k 50 kHz spur on 156.25 MHz output –82 –83 –83 –100 –83 dBc PSNR100k 100 kHz spur on 156.25 MHz output –83 –82 –82 –100 –77 dBc PSNR500k 500 kHz spur on 156.25 MHz output –72 –82 –82 –100 –75 dBc PSNR1M 1 MHz spur on 156.25 MHz output –76 –83 –83 –100 –80 dBc (1) Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. 8.28 Typical Power-Supply Noise Rejection Characteristics (1) VDD_IN / VDD_PLL / VDD_LDO / VDD_DIG= 3.3 V, VDDO_x = 1.8 V, TA = 25°C, Reference Input = 50 MHz, PFD = 100 MHz, PLL bandwidth = 400 kHz, VCO frequency = 5 GHz, post divider = 8, output divider = 4, AC-LVPECL/AC-LVDS/CML output pair AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential load, HCSL outputs with 50 Ω || 2 pF to GND, sinusoidal noise injected in VDDO_x. 25-mV RIPPLE ON SUPPLY TYPE PARAMETER VDD_IN VDD_PLL VDD_LDO VDD_DIG VDDO_x UNIT PSNR50k 50 kHz spur on 156.25 MHz output n/a n/a n/a n/a -63 dBc PSNR100k 100 kHz spur on 156.25 MHz output n/a n/a n/a n/a -60 dBc PSNR500k 500 kHz spur on 156.25 MHz output n/a n/a n/a n/a -63 dBc PSNR1M 1 MHz spur on 156.25 MHz output n/a n/a n/a n/a -71 dBc (1) Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. 8.29 Typical Closed-Loop Output Spur Characteristics (1) VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_DIG = 3.3V, VDDO_x = 1.8 V, 2.5 V, 3.3 V, TA = –40°C to +85°C, 50 MHz reference input, 156.25 MHz or 125 MHz output with VCO frequency = 5 GHz, integer-N PLL, PLL bandwidth = 400 kHz, post divider = 8, output divider = 4 or 5, 161.1328125 MHz output with VCO frequency = 5.15625 GHz, fractional-N PLL, PLL bandwidth = 400 kHz, post divider = 8, output divider = 4, LVCMOS output load of 2 pF to GND, AC-LVPECL/AC-LVDS/AC-CML output pair AC-coupled to 100 Ω differential load, HCSL outputs with 50 Ω || 2 pF to GND OUTPUT TYPE PARAMETER CONDITION ACLVPECL AC-LVDS AC-CML HCSL LVCMOS UNIT PSPUR-PFD PFD/reference clock spurs 156.25 ± 78.125 MHz –77 –74 –76 –73 –75 dBc PSPUR-PFD PFD/reference clock spurs 161.1328125 ± 80.56640625 MHz –80 –77 –79 –77 –82 dBc PSPUR-FRAC Largest fractional PLL spurs 161.1328125 ± 80.56640625 MHz –74 –73 –76 –73 –74 dBc PSPUR-OUT Output channel-tochannel isolation fVICTIM = 156.25 MHz OUT4, fAGGR = 125 MHz OUT5, ACLVPECL aggressor –73 –70 –70 –67 –74 dBc PSPUR-OUT Output channel-tochannel isolation fVICTIM = 156.25 MHz OUT4, fAGGR = 125 MHz OUT5, ACLVDS aggressor –76 –74 –75 –71 –79 dBc PSPUR-OUT Output channel-tochannel isolation fVICTIM = 156.25 MHz OUT4, fAGGR = 125 MHz OUT5, HCSL aggressor –78 –74 –75 –72 –77 dBc PSPUR–OUT Output channel-tochannel isolation fVICTIM = 156.25 MHz OUT4, fAGGR = 125 MHz OUT5, LVCMOS aggressor –72 –70 –71 –66 –73 dBc (1) 16 Refer to Parameter Measurement Information for relevant test conditions. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 ±228.5 ±110 ±229.0 ±120 Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) PLL Figure of Merit (dBc/Hz) 8.30 Typical Characteristics ±229.5 ±230.0 ±230.5 ±231.0 ±150 ±170 0 1 2 3 4 5 Input Slew Rate (V/ns) 6 100 1000 ±120 ±120 Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) ±110 ±140 ±150 100000 1000000 10000000 D004 Figure 2. Closed Loop Phase Noise of AC-LVPECL Outputs at 156.25 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 ±110 ±130 10000 Offset Frequency (Hz) D003 Figure 1. PLL Figure of Merit (FOM) vs Slew Rate Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) ±140 ±160 ±231.5 ±160 ±130 ±140 ±150 ±160 ±170 ±170 100 1000 10000 100000 1000000 10000000 Offset Frequency (Hz) 100 1000 ±120 ±120 Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) ±110 ±140 ±150 ±160 100000 1000000 10000000 D006 Figure 4. Closed Loop Phase Noise of AC-CML Outputs at 156.25 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 ±110 ±130 10000 Offset Frequency (Hz) D005 Figure 3. Closed Loop Phase Noise of AC-LVDS Outputs at 156.25 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) ±130 ±130 ±140 ±150 ±160 ±170 ±170 100 1000 10000 100000 1000000 10000000 Offset Frequency (Hz) 100 Figure 5. Closed Loop Phase Noise of HCSL Outputs at 156.25 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 1000 10000 100000 1000000 10000000 Offset Frequency (Hz) D007 D008 Figure 6. Closed Loop Phase Noise of AC-LVPECL Outputs at 161.1328125 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5.15625 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 17 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com ±110 ±110 ±120 ±120 Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) Typical Characteristics (continued) ±130 ±140 ±150 ±160 ±130 ±140 ±150 ±160 ±170 ±170 100 1000 10000 100000 1000000 10000000 Offset Frequency (Hz) 100 1000 10000 100000 1000000 10000000 Offset Frequency (Hz) D009 Figure 7. Closed Loop Phase Noise of AC-LVDS Outputs at 161.1328125 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 D010 Figure 8. Closed Loop Phase Noise of AC-CML Outputs at 161.1328125 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 10 ±110 0 -10 ±130 Amplitude (dBm) Phase Noise (dBc/Hz) ±120 ±140 ±150 ±160 -40 -50 -60 -80 100 1000 10000 100000 1000000 10000000 Offset Frequency (Hz) -90 78.125 140.625 171.875 Frequency (MHz) 203.125 234.375 D012 Figure 10. 156.25 ± 78.125 MHz AC-LVPECL Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 10 10 0 -10 -20 -20 Amplitude (dBm) 0 -10 -30 -40 -50 -60 -30 -40 -50 -60 -70 -70 -80 -80 -90 78.125 109.375 D011 Figure 9. Closed Loop Phase Noise of HCSL Outputs at 161.1328125 MHz with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 Amplitude (dBm) -30 -70 ±170 109.375 140.625 171.875 Frequency (MHz) 203.125 234.375 -90 78.125 D013 Figure 11. 156.25 ± 78.125 MHz AC-LVDS Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 18 -20 109.375 140.625 171.875 Frequency (MHz) 203.125 234.375 D014 Figure 12. \156.25 ± 78.125 MHz AC-CML Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Typical Characteristics (continued) 10 0 0 -10 -10 -20 -20 Amplitude (dBm) Amplitude (dBm) 10 -30 -40 -50 -60 -30 -40 -50 -60 -70 -70 -80 -80 -90 78.125 -90 109.375 140.625 171.875 Frequency (MHz) 203.125 -100 80 234.375 Figure 13. 156.25 ± 78.125 MHz HCSL Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 1 MHz, Integer N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 120 140 160 180 Frequency (MHz) 200 220 240 D016 Figure 14. 161.1328125 ± 80.56640625 MHz AC-LVPECL Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5.15625 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 10 10 0 0 -10 -10 -20 -20 Amplitude (dBm) Amplitude (dBm) 100 D015 -30 -40 -50 -60 -30 -40 -50 -60 -70 -70 -80 -80 -90 -90 -100 80 -100 80 100 120 140 160 180 Frequency (MHz) 200 220 240 100 120 D017 Figure 15. 161.1328125 ± 80.56640625 MHz AC-LVDS Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5.15625 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 140 160 180 Frequency (MHz) 200 220 240 D018 Figure 16. 161.1328125 ± 80.56640625 MHz AC-CML Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5.15625 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 10 1.7 Output Differential Swing (Vp-p) 0 -10 Amplitude (dBm) -20 -30 -40 -50 -60 -70 -80 1.6 1.5 1.4 1.3 1.2 -90 -100 80 1.1 100 120 140 160 180 Frequency (MHz) 200 220 240 0 D019 Figure 17. 161.1328125 ± 80.56640625 MHz HCSL Output Spectrum with PLL Bandwidth at 400 kHz, Fractional N PLL, 50 MHz Crystal Input, 5.15625 GHz VCO Frequency, Post Divider = 8, Output Divider = 4 200 400 600 Output Frequency (MHz) 800 1000 D020 Figure 18. AC-LVPECL Differential Output Swing vs Frequency Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 19 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Typical Characteristics (continued) 1.3 Output Differential Swing (Vp-p) Output Differential Swing (Vp-p) 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 1.2 1.15 1.1 1.05 1 0.95 0.9 0 200 400 600 Output Frequency (MHz) 800 1000 0 200 D021 Figure 19. AC-LVDS Differential Output Swing vs Frequency 1.5 2 1.45 1.9 1.4 1.35 400 600 Output Frequency (MHz) 800 1000 D022 Figure 20. AC-CML Differential Output Swing vs Frequency Output Swing (V) Output Differential Swing (Vp-p) 1.25 1.8 1.7 1.3 1.6 0 100 200 300 Output Frequency (MHz) 400 0 D023 Figure 21. HCSL Differential Output Swing vs Frequency 50 100 150 Output Frequency (MHz) 200 D024 Figure 22. 1.8-V LVCMOS (on OUT[7:0]) Output Swing vs Frequency 3.5 Output Swing (V) 3.4 3.3 3.2 3.1 3 2.9 0 50 100 150 Output Frequency (MHz) 200 D025 Figure 23. 3.3-V LVCMOS (on STATUS[1:0]) Output Swing vs Frequency 20 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 9 Parameter Measurement Information 9.1 Test Configurations This section describes the characterization test setup of each block in the LMK03318. High impedance probe LVCMOS LMK03318 Oscilloscope 2 pF Figure 24. LVCMOS Output DC Configuration During Device Test Phase Noise/ Spectrum Analyzer LVCMOS LMK03318 Figure 25. LVCMOS Output AC Configuration During Device Test High impedance differential probe AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML LMK03318 Oscilloscope Figure 26. AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML Output DC Configuration During Device Test High impedance differential probe HCSL LMK03318 Oscilloscope HCSL 50 50 Figure 27. HCSL Output DC Configuration during Device Test AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML Diff-to-SE Balun/Buffer LMK03318 Phase Noise/ Spectrum Analyzer AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML Figure 28. AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML Output AC Configuration During Device Test Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 21 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Test Configurations (continued) HCSL LMK03318 50 Phase Noise/ Spectrum Analyzer Balun HCSL 50 Figure 29. HCSL Output AC Configuration During Device Test Signal Generator PRI_REF LVCMOS LMK03318 Offset = VDD_IN/2 Figure 30. LVCMOS Primary Input DC Configuration During Device Test Signal Generator LVCMOS 125 SEC_REF LMK03318 Offset = VDD_IN/2 375 Figure 31. LVCMOS Secondary Input DC Configuration During Device Test Signal Generator LVDS LMK03318 100 Figure 32. LVDS Input DC Configuration During Device Test Signal Generator LMK03318 LVPECL 50 50 VDD_IN - 2 Figure 33. LVPECL Input DC Configuration During Device Test 22 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Test Configurations (continued) 50 Signal Generator HCSL LMK03318 50 Figure 34. HCSL Input DC Configuration During Device Test Signal Generator LMK03318 Differential 100 Figure 35. Differential Input AC Configuration during Device Test Crystal LMK03318 Figure 36. Crystal Reference Input Configuration During Device Test Sine wave Modulator Power Supply Signal Generator LMK03318 Reference Input Device Output Balun Phase Noise/ Spectrum Analyzer Figure 37. PSRR Test Setup Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 23 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Test Configurations (continued) OUTx_P VOD OUTx_N 80% VOUT,DIFF,PP = 2 x VOD 0V 20% tR tF Figure 38. Differential Output Voltage and Rise/Fall Time 80% VOUT,SE OUT_REFx/2 20% tR tF Figure 39. Single Ended Output Voltage and Rise/Fall Time OUTx_P Differential OUTx_N tSK,DIFF,INT OUTx_P Differential OUTx_N tSK,SE-DIFF,INT OUTx_P/N Single Ended tSK,SE,INT Single Ended OUTx_P/N Figure 40. Differential and Single-Ended Output Skew 24 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10 Detailed Description 10.1 Overview The LMK03318 generates eight outputs with less than 0.2 ps, rms maximum random jitter in integer PLL mode and less than 0.35 ps, rms maximum random jitter in fractional PLL mode with a crystal input or a clean external reference input. 10.2 Functional Block Diagram VCC (x4) 3.3 V C2 VCCO (x6) 1.8 / 2.5 / 3.3 V LF Power Conditioning Outputs (1.8 / 2.5 / 3.3 V) SYNC Inputs (1.8 / 2.5 / 3.3 V) REFSEL OUT0 PRIREF X1, x2 R Div 3-b Integer Div 8-b PLL (3.3 V) /2, /3, /4, /5, /6, /7, /8 ¥ OUT2 X1, x2 XO SECREF VCO: 4.8 GHz ~ 5.4 GHz Integer Div 8-b OUT3 N Div MARGIN ™û fractional Integer Div 8-b 0 1 2 OUT4 Integer Div 8-b 0 1 2 OUT5 Integer Div 8-b 0 1 2 OUT6 Integer Div 8-b 0 1 2 OUT7 /4, /5 Control (1.8 / 2.5 / 3.3 V) Registers Integer Div /6 - /256 EEPROM SYNC AC-LVDS, AC-LVPECL, AC-CML, HCSL or 1.8-V LVCMOS OUT1 M Div 3-b SDA od SCL od Device Control and Status PDN GPIO[5:0] 3 STATUS1 3 = 3-level input od = open-drain STATUS0 CAP (x3) 3.3-V LVCMOS NOTE Input and control blocks are compatible with 1.8 V, 2.5 V, or 3.3 V I/O voltage levels. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 25 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.3 Feature Description 10.3.1 Device Block-Level Description The LMK03318 includes an on-chip fractional PLL with integrated VCO that supports a frequency range of 4.8 GHz to 5.4 GHz. The PLL block consists of an input selection MUX, a phase frequency detector (PFD), charge pump, on-chip passive loop filter that only needs an external capacitor to ground, a feedback divider that can support both integer and fractional values, and a delta-sigma engine for spur suppression in fractional PLL mode. The universal inputs support single-ended and differential clocks in the frequencies of 1 MHz to 300 MHz; the secondary input additionally supports crystals in the frequencies of 10 MHz to 52 MHz. When the PLL operates with the crystal as its reference, the output frequencies can be margined based on changing the on-chip capacitor loading on each leg of the crystal. Completing the device is the combination of integer output dividers and universal output buffers. The PLL is powered by on-chip low dropout (LDO) linear voltage regulators, and the regulated supply network is partitioned such that the sensitive analog supplies are running from separate LDOs than the digital supplies which use their own LDO. The LDOs provide isolation of the isolation of the PLL from any noise in the external power supply rail with a PSRR of better than –60 dBc at 50 kHz to 1 MHz ripple frequencies at 1.8 V output supplies and better than –70 dBc at 50 kHz to 1 MHz ripple frequencies at > 2.5 V output supplies. The regulator capacitor pins must each be connected to ground by 10 µF capacitors to ensure stability. 10.3.2 Device Configuration Control Figure 41 shows the relationships between device states, the configuration pins, device initialization and configuration, and device operational modes. In hard-pin-configuration mode, the state of the configuration pins determines the configuration of the device as selected from all device states programmed in the on-chip ROM. In soft-pin-configuration mode, the state of the configuration pins determines the initialized state of the device as programmed in the on-chip EEPROM. In either mode, the host can update any device configuration after the device enables the host interface and the host writes a sequence that updates the device registers. Once the device configuration is set, the host can also write to the on-chip EEPROM for a new set of power-up defaults based on the configuration pin settings in the soft-pin-configuration mode. A system may transition a device from hard-pin mode to soft-pin mode by changing the state of the HW_SW_CTRL pin, then triggering a device power cycling via the PDN pin. In reset mode, the device disables the outputs so that unwanted sporadic activity associated with device initialization does not appear on the device outputs. Table 2 lists the functionality of the GPIO[5:0] pins during hard pin and soft pin modes. 26 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Feature Description (continued) Power-on Internal Reset Pulse or PDN Pin 0 1 Sample HW_SW_CTRL GPIO[5] is multi-state; GPIO[4] and GPIO[0] are 2-state; GPIO[3:1] are 3-state GPIO[5:0] are 2-state Hard pin mode I2C is still enabled, LSB of I2C address is 00 Soft pin mode I2C enabled. Sample GPIO[5:0] for selecting 1 of 64 pre-defined ROM settings Sample GPIO1 Sample GPIO[3:2] GPIO1 determines 1 of 3 2 I C Addresses GPIO[3:2] selects PLL and output types/divider/source for up to 6 EEPROM configurations. Leaving the pins floating bypasses EEPROM loading and register defaults are loaded. GPIO[5] selects one of eight crystal frequency margining offset settings and GPIO[4] enables/disables crystal frequency margining control. Save desired configuration into the corresponding EEPROM page User can operate from EEPROM loaded configurations or reprogram the device register via I2C Figure 41. LMK03318 Simplified Programming Flow Table 2. GPIO Pin Mapping for Hard Pin Mode and Soft Pin Mode PIN NAME GPIO0 GPIO1 HARD-PIN MODE SOFT-PIN MODE FUNCTION STATE FUNCTION STATE ROM page select for hard pin mode 2 Output synchronization (active low) 2 2 2 I C slave address LSB select 3 GPIO2 2 3 GPIO3 2 EEPROM page select for soft pin mode or register default mode GPIO4 2 Frequency margining enable 2 GPIO5 2 Frequency margining offset select 8 3 10.3.2.1 Hard-Pin Mode (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) In this mode, the GPIO[5:0] pins allow hardware pin configuration of the PLL synthesizer, its input clock selection, and output frequency and type selection. I2C is still enabled, and the LSB of device address is set to 00 . The GPIO pins are 2-state and are sampled or latched at POR — the combination selects one of 64 page settings that are predefined in on-chip ROM. In this mode, automatic output divider and PLL post divider synchronization is performed on power up or upon toggling PDN. Table 14, Table 15, Table 17 and Table 18 show the pre-defined ROM configurations according to the GPIO[5:0] pin settings. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 27 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Following are the blocks that are configured by the GPIO[5:0] pins. 10.3.2.1.1 PLL Block Sets the PLL synthesizer frequency and loop bandwidth by configuring registers related to the PLL dividers, input frequency doubler, and PLL power down. 10.3.2.1.2 Output Buffer Auto Mute When the selected source of an output MUX is invalid (for example, the PLL is unlocked or selected reference input is not present), the individual output mute controls will determine output mute state per the ROM default settings (CH_x_MUTE=1, CHx_MUTE_LVL=3): 1. In differential mode, the positive output node is driven to the internal regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load), and the negative output node is driven to the GND rail. 2. In LVCMOS mode, a DC connection to the receiver is assumed, so the output in a “mute” condition will be forced LOW. 10.3.2.1.3 Input Block Sets the input type for primary and secondary inputs, selects input MUX type for the PLL, and selects R divider value for primary input to the input MUX. 10.3.2.1.4 Channel Mux Controls the channel mux selection for each channel. 10.3.2.1.5 Output Divider Sets the 8-bit output divide value for each channel (/1 to /256). 10.3.2.1.6 Output Driver Format Selects the output format for each driver pair, or disable channel. 10.3.2.1.7 Status MUX, Divider and Slew Rate Selects the status pins as either 3.3-V LVCMOS PLL clock outputs or status outputs. When configured as LVCMOS clock outputs, selects divider values and rise/fall time settings. 10.3.2.2 Soft-Pin Programming Mode (HW_SW_CTRL = 0) In this mode, I2C is enabled and GPIO[3:2] are purposed as 3-state pins (tied to VDD_DIG, GND or VIM) and used to select one of 6 EEPROM pages and one register default setting (2 of 9 states are invalid). GPIO[0] is also purposed as a 2-state output synchronization (active-low SYNCN) function, GPIO[1] is now purposed as a 3-state I2C address function to change last 2 bits of I2C address (ADD; 00 is GND, 01 is VIM, and 11 is VDD_DIG). GPIO[5] is purposed as a multi-state input for the MARGIN function and GPIO[4] is purposed as an input that enables or disables hardware margining. The GPIO pins are sampled/latched at POR. NOTE No software reset or power cycling must occur during EEPROM programming or else it will be corrupted. Please refer to Interface and Control for more details on the EEPROM programming. GPIO[3:2] allows hardware pin configuration for the PLL synthesizers, their respective input clock selection modes, the crystal input frequency margining option, all output channel blocks, comprised of channel muxes, dividers, and output drivers. The GPIO inputs[3:2] are sampled and latched at power-on/reset (POR), and selects one of 6 EEPROM pages, which are custom-programmable. When GPIO[3:2] are left floating, EEPROM is not used, and the hardware register default settings are loaded. Table 10, Table 11, Table 12 and Table 13 show the pre-defined EEPROM configurations according to the GPIO[3:2] pin settings. Below is a brief overview of each block’s register settings configured by the GPIO[3:2] pin modes. 28 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.3.2.2.1 Device Config Space 8-b for unique identifier programmed to EEPROM that can be used to distinguish between each EEPROM page. 10.3.2.2.2 PLL Block Sets the PLL synthesizer frequency and loop bandwidth by configuring registers related to the PLL dividers, input frequency doubler, and PLL power down. 10.3.2.2.3 Output Buffer Auto Mute When the selected source of an output MUX is invalid (for example, the PLL is unlocked or selected reference input is not present), the individual output mute controls determine output mute state per the EEPROM default settings (CH_x_MUTE=1, CHx_MUTE_LVL=3): 1. In differential mode, the positive output node is driven to the internal regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load), and the negative output node is driven to the GND rail. 2. In LVCMOS mode, we will be assuming a DC connection to the receiver, so the output in a “mute” condition is forced LOW. 10.3.2.2.4 Input Block Sets the input type for primary and secondary inputs, selects input MUX type for the PLL and selects R divider value for primary input to the input MUX. 10.3.2.2.5 Channel Mux Controls the channel mux selection for each channel. 10.3.2.2.6 Output Divider Sets the 8-bit output divide value for each channel (/1 to /256). 10.3.2.2.7 Output Driver Format Selects the output format for each driver pair, or disables channel. 10.3.2.2.8 Status MUX, Divider and Slew Rate Selects the status pins as either 3.3-V LVCMOS PLL clock outputs or status outputs. When configured as LVCMOS clock outputs, selects divider values and rise/fall time settings. 10.3.2.3 Register File Reference Convention Figure 42 shows the method that this document employs to refer to an individual register bit or a grouping of register bits. If a drawing or text references an individual bit the format is to specify the register number first and the bit number second. The LMK03318 contains 124 registers that are 8 bits wide. The register addresses and the bit positions both begin with the number zero (0). A period separates the register address and bit address. The first bit in the register file is address ‘R0.0’ meaning that it is located in Register 0 and is bit position 0. The last bit in the register file is addressR31.7 referring to the 8th bit of register address 31 (the 32nd register in the device). Figure 42 lists specific bit positions as a number contained within a box. A box with the register address encloses the group of boxes that represent the bits relevant to the specific device circuitry in context. Reg5 Register Number (s) 5 4 Bit Number (s) 3 2 R5.2 Figure 42. LMK03318 Register Reference Format Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 29 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.4 Configuring the Device The PLL in LMK03318 can be configured to accommodate various input and output frequencies either through I2C programming interface or in the absence of programming, the PLL can be configured by the ROM page, EEPROM page, or register default settings selected through the control pins. The PLL can be configured by setting its Smart Input MUX, Reference Divider, PLL Loop Filter, Feedback Divider, Prescaler Divider and Output Dividers. For the PLL to operate in closed loop mode, the following condition in Equation 1 has to be met when using primary input or secondary input for the reference clock (FREF). FVCO = (FREF/R) × D × [(INT + NUM/DEN)/M] where • • • • • • • • FVCO: PLL/VCO Frequency FREF: Frequency of selected reference input clock D: PLL input frequency doubler, 1=Disabled, 2=Enabled INT: PLL feedback divider integer value (12 bits, 1 to 4095) NUM: PLL feedback divider fractional numerator value ( 22 bits, 0 to 4194303) DEN: PLL feedback divider fractional denominator value ( 22 bits, 1 to 4194303) R: Primary reference divider value (3 bits, 1 to 8); R = 1 for secondary reference M: PLL reference input divider value (5 bits, 1 to 32) (1) The output frequency is related to the PLL/VCO frequency or the reference input frequency (based on the output MUX selection) as given in the following equations. FOUT = FREF when reference input clock selected by OUTMUX FOUT = FVCO / (P × OUTDIV) when PLL is selected by OUTMUX (2) where • • OUTDIV: Output divider value (8 bits, 1 to 256) P: PLL post-divider value (2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8) (3) 10.4.1 Smart Input MUX The PLL has a Smart Input MUX. The input selection mode of the PLL can be configured using the 3-state REFSEL pin or programmed via I2C. The Smart Input MUX supports auto-switching and manual-switching using control pin (or through register). The Smart Input MUX is designed such that glitches created during switching in both auto and manual modes are suppressed at the MUX output. In the automatic mode, the frequencies of both primary (PRIREF) and secondary (SECREF) input clocks have to be within 2000 ppm. The phase of the input clocks can be any. In order to minimize phase jump at the output, it is recommended to set very low PLL loop bandwidth, set R29.7 = 1, R51.7 = 1, and those outputs that are not be muted should have its respective mute bypass bit in R20 and R21 be set to 0 in order to ensure that these outputs are available during an input switchover event. In the case the primary reference is detected to be unavailable, the input MUX automatically switches from the primary reference to the secondary reference. When primary reference is detected to be available again, the input MUX switches back to the primary reference. When both primary and secondary references are detected as unavailable, the input MUX waits on secondary reference until either the primary or the secondary reference is detected as available again. When both the primary and secondary reference inputs are detected as unavailable, LOS is active, and the PLL outputs are automatically disabled. The timing diagram of an auto-switch at the input MUX is shown in Figure 43. PRI_REF 1 SEC_REF 1 2 3 4 2 Internal Reference Clock Figure 43. Smart Input MUX Auto-Switch Mode Timing Diagram 30 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Configuring the Device (continued) R50[1-0] are the register bits that control the smart input MUX for the PLL and can be programmed through I2C. Table 3 shows the input clock selection options for the PLL that are supported by the REFSEL pin or via I2C programming. Table 3. Input Clock Selection via I2C Programming or REFSEL Pin R50.1 R50.0 REFSEL MODE 0 0 X Automatic PLL prefers primary PLL REFERENCE 0 1 0 Manual PLL selects primary 0 1 VIM Manual PLL selects secondary 0 1 1 Automatic PLL prefers primary 1 0 X Manual PLL selects primary 1 1 X Manual PLL selects secondary For those applications requiring device start-up from a crystal on the secondary input, then do a one-time-only switchover to the primary input once available and when auto-switch on the PLL's smart MUX is enabled, R51.2 can be set to 0 which automatically disables the secondary crystal input path after switchover to the primary input is complete. This removes coupling between the primary and secondary inputs and prevents input Ωcrosstalk components from appearing at the outputs. However, if the auto-switch between primary and secondary is desired at any point of normal device operation, R51.2 must be set to 1, PLL must be set to a very low loop bandwidth, and R20, R21 and R22 must be set to 0x0 in order to ensure minimal phase hit once PLL is relocked after switchover to either primary or secondary inputs. Figure 44 shows flowchart of events triggered when R51.2 is set to 1 or 0 . Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 31 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com no ,V 3//¶V 60$5708; VHW WR Auto Select? yes R51.2 0 1 Single auto-switch event Multiple auto-switch event Startup from XTAL (SECREF) Startup from XTAL (SECREF) PLL locked to SECREF PLL locked to SECREF no no Is PRIREF Valid? Is PRIREF Valid? SECREF turned on Auto switch to SECREF PLL unlocked momentarily (~ ms) and large phase hit yes yes Auto switch to PRIREF SECREF turned off Auto switch to PRIREF SECREF left on Auto switch to SECREF Minimal phase hit during auto switch no no yes PLL locked to PRIREF No impact to phase noise/spurs from freq difference between PRIREF and SECREF since SECREF is turned off yes PLL locked to PRIREF Onus on customer to minimize freq difference between PRIREF and SECREF Otherwise phase noise/spur impact Is PRIREF Valid? Is PRIREF Valid? Figure 44. Flowchart Describing Events When R51.2 is Set to 0 or 1 32 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.4.2 Universal Input Buffer (PRI_REF, SEC_REF) The primary reference can support differential or single ended clocks. The secondary reference can support differential or single ended clocks or crystal. The differential input buffers on both primary and secondary support internal 50 Ω to ground or 100 Ω termination between P and N followed by on-chip AC coupling capacitors to internal self-biased circuitry. Internal biasing is offered before the on-chip AC coupling capacitors when the clock inputs are AC coupled externally and this is enabled by setting R29.0 = 1 (for primary reference) or R29.1 = 1 (for secondary reference). When the clock inputs are DC coupled, the internal biasing before the on-chip AC coupling capacitors is disabled by settings R29.0 = 0 (for primary reference) or R29.1 = 0 (for secondary reference). Figure 45 shows the differential input buffer termination options implemented on both primary and secondary and the switches (SWLVDS, SWHCSL, SWAC) are controlled by R29[5-0]. Table 4 shows the primary and secondary buffer configuration matrix for LVPECL, CML, LVDS, HCSL and LVCMOS inputs. LMK03318 Differential Input Control 7 pF PRIREF_P / SECREF_P SWHCSL R29.4, R29.5 50 50 SWLVDS R29.2, R29.3 SWAC R29.0, R29.1 Vbb = 1.3 V (weak bias) PRI_REF / SEC_REF SWAC R29.0, R29.1 50 PRIREF_N / SECREF_N SWHCSL R29.4, R29.5 7 pF 50 R29 5 4 3 2 1 0 Figure 45. Differential Input Buffer Termination Options on Primary and Secondary Reference Table 4. Input Buffer Configuration Matrix on Primary and/or Secondary Reference (1) R50.5 / R50.7 R50.4 / R50.6 R29.4 / R29.5 R29.2 / R29.3 R29.0 / R29.1 (1) MODE EXTERNAL COUPLING TERMINATIO N BIASING HCSL AC Internal Internal 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 LVDS AC Internal Internal 0 1 0 1 1 LVPECL AC Internal Internal 0 1 0 1 1 CML AC Internal Internal 0 1 1 0 0 HCSL DC Internal External When termination is set to External, internal on-chip termination of LMK03318 should be disabled. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 33 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 4. Input Buffer Configuration Matrix on Primary and/or Secondary Reference() (continued) R50.5 / R50.7 R50.4 / R50.6 R29.4 / R29.5 R29.2 / R29.3 R29.0 / R29.1 MODE EXTERNAL COUPLING TERMINATIO N BIASING 0 1 0 1 0 LVDS DC Internal External 0 1 0 0 0 LVPECL DC External External 0 1 0 0 0 CML DC External External 0 0 0 0 0 LVCMOS DC N/A N/A Figure 46 through Figure 55 show recommendations for interfacing primary or secondary inputs of the LMK03318 with LVCMOS, LVPECL, LVDS, CML and HCSL drivers, respectively. NOTE The secondary reference accepts up to 2.6-V maximum swing when LVCMOS input option is selected. RS 3.3-V LVCMOS Driver PRI_REF LVCMOS LMK03318 Figure 46. Interfacing LMK03318 Primary Input With 3.3-V LVCMOS Signal 3.3-V LVCMOS Driver RS 125 LVCMOS SEC_REF LMK03318 375 Figure 47. Interfacing LMK03318 Secondary Input With 3.3-V LVCMOS Signal LVPECL Driver LMK03318 LVPECL 50 50 VDDO - 2 Figure 48. DC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs With LVPECL Signal LVDS Driver LVDS LMK03318 100 Figure 49. DC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs with LVDS Signal CML Driver CML LMK03318 Figure 50. DC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs with CML Signal 34 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 50 HCSL Driver LMK03318 HCSL 50 Figure 51. DC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs With HCSL Signal LVPECL Driver LMK03318 LVPECL 100 RPD RPD Figure 52. AC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs With LVPECL Signal (internal biasing enabled) LVDS Driver LMK03318 LVDS 100 Figure 53. AC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs With LVDS Signal (internal biasing enabled) CML Driver CML LMK03318 100 Figure 54. AC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs With CML Signal (internal biasing enabled) 50 HCSL Driver HCSL LMK03318 100 50 Figure 55. AC Coupling LMK03318 Inputs With HCSL Signal (internal biasing enabled) 10.4.3 Crystal Input Interface (SEC_REF) The LMK03318 implements an input crystal oscillator circuitry, known as the Pierce oscillator, shown in Figure 56. It is enabled when R50[7-6], and R29.1 are set to 1, 0, and 1, respectively. The crystal oscillator circuitry includes programmable on-chip capacitances on each leg of the crystal and a damping resistor intended to minimize overdriven condition of the crystal. The recommended oscillation mode of operation for the input crystal is fundamental mode, and the recommended type of circuit for the crystal is parallel resonance with low or high pullability. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 35 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com A crystal’s load capacitance refers to all capacitances in the oscillator feedback loop. It is equal to the amount of capacitance seen between the terminals of the crystal in the circuit. For parallel resonant mode circuits, the correct load capacitance is necessary to ensure the oscillation of the crystal within the expected parameters. The LMK03318 has been characterized with 9-pF parallel resonant crystals with maximum motional resistance of 30 Ω and maximum drive level of 300 µW. The normalized frequency error of the crystal, due to load capacitance mismatch, can be calculated as: CS '¦ ¦ 2(CL,R CS C0 ) 2(CL,A C0 ) where • • • • • • CS is the motional capacitance of the crystal C0 is the shunt capacitance of the crystal CL,R is the rated load capacitance for the crystal CL,A is the actual load capacitance in the implemented PCB for the crystal Δƒ is the frequency error of the crystal ƒ is the rated frequency of the crystal. (4) The first 3 parameters can be obtained from the crystal vendor. SECREF_P SECREF_N LMK03318 Crystal Input Control 500 Con-chip Con-chip R50 7 6 R29 R86 R87 R90 R91 R92 R93 R94 R95 R96 R97 R98 R99 R100 R101 R102 R103 R104 R105 R106 1 Figure 56. Crystal Input Interface on Secondary Reference If reducing frequency error of the crystal is of utmost improtance, a crystal with low pullability should be used. If frequency margining or frequency spiking is desired, a crystal with high pullability should be used to ensure that the desired frequency offset is added to the nominal oscillation frequency. A total of ±50 ppm pulling range is obtained with a crystal whose ratio of shunt capacitance to motional capacitance (C0/C1) is no more than 250. 36 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 The programmable capacitors on LMK03318 can be tuned from 14 pF to 24 pF in steps of 14 fF using either an analog voltage on GPIO5 in soft pin mode or via I2C in soft pin or hard pin mode. When using crystals with low pullability, preferred method is to program R86.3 = 1, R86.2 = 0, and program the appropriate binary code to R104 and R105, in this exact order, that sets the required on-chip load capacitance for least frequency error. GPIO4 pin must be tied to VDD, and GPIO5 pin should be floating when device is operating in soft-pin mode. Table 4 shows the binary code for on-chip load capacitance on each leg of crystal. When using crystals with high pullability, same method as above can be repeated for setting a fixed frequency offset to the nominal oscillation frequency according to Equation 4. In case of a closed loop system where the crystal frequency can be dynamically changed based on a control signal, the LMK03318 must operate in soft-pin mode, R86.3 must be programmed to 0, and R86.2 must be programmed to 1. The GPIO5 pin is now configured as an 8-level input with a full-scale range of 0 V to 1.8 V, and every 200 mV corresponds to a frequency change, according to Equation 4. There are three possibilities to enable margining feature with GPIO5: • Programming R86.3 = 0 and R86.2 = 1. In this case, status of GPIO4 pin is ignored. • When R86.3 = 0 and R86.2 = 0 is programmed, GPIO4 must be tied to GND. Tying GPIO4 to VDD disables GPIO5 for margining purposes and R94 and R95 determine the on-chip load capacitance for the crystal. If any frequency offset is desired at the output, the appropriate binary code should be programmed to R94 and R95. • When R86.3 = 1 and R86.2 = 0 is programmed, GPIO4 must be tied to GND. Tying GPIO4 to VDD disables GPIO5 for margining purposes and R104 and R105 determine the on-chip load capacitance for the crystal. If any frequency offset is desired at the output, the appropriate binary code should be programmed to R104 and R105. There are two possibilities to drive the GPIO5 pin: • The first method is to achieve the desired voltage between 0 V to 1.8 V according to Analog Input Characteristics (GPIO[5]). The pulldown resistor value sets the voltage on GPIO[5] pin that falls within one of eight settings whose pre-programmed on-chip crystal load capacitances are set by R88, R89, R90, R91, R92, R93, R94, R95, R96, R97, R98, R99, R100, R101, R102 and R103. • The second method is using a low-pass filtered PWM signal to drive the 8-level GPIO5 pin as shown in Figure 57. The PWM signal could be generated from the frequency difference between a highly stable TCXO and the output of LMK03318 that is provided as a feedback into the GPIO5 pin and used to adjust the on-chip load capacitance on the crystal input in order to reduce frequency errors from the crystal. This is a quick alternative that produces a frequency error at the LMK03318's output and could be acceptable to any application when compared to a full-characterization with a chosen crystal to understand the exact load pulling required to minimize frequency error at the LMK03318's output. More details on frequency margining are provided in Application and Implementation. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 37 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com SECREF_P SECREF_N LMK03318 Crystal Input Control 500 GPIO5 PWM Con-chip DSP Con-chip Low Pass Filter Figure 57. Crystal Load Capacitance Compensation using PWM Signal 38 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 The incremental load capacitance for each step should be programmed to R88, R89, R90, R91, R92, R93, R94, R95, R96, R97, R98, R99, R100, R101, R102, and R103 according to the chosen crystal's trim sensitivity specifications. The least-significant bit programmed to any of the XO offset register corresponds to a load capacitance delta of about 0.02 pF on the crystal input pins. Good layout practices are fundamental to the correct operation and reliability of the oscillator. It is critical to locate the crystal components very close to the SECREF_P and SECREF_N pins to minimize routing distances. Long traces in the oscillator circuit are a very common source of problems. Don’t route other signals across the oscillator circuit, and make sure power and high-frequency traces are routed as far away as possible to avoid crosstalk and noise coupling. If drive level of the crystal should be reduced, a damping resistor (less than 500 Ω) should be accommodated in the layout between the crystal leg and SECREF_P pin. Vias in the oscillator circuit are recommended primarily for connections to the ground plane. Don’t share ground connections; instead, make a separate connection to ground for each component that requires grounding. If possible, place multiple vias in parallel for each connection to the ground plane. The layout must be designed to minimize stray capacitance across the crystal to less than 2 pF total under all circumstances to ensure proper crystal oscillation. 10.4.4 Reference Doubler The primary and secondary references each have a frequency doubler that can be enabled by programming R57.4 = 1 for the primary reference and R72.4 = 1 for the secondary reference. Enabling the doubler allows a higher comparison frequency for the PLL and results in a 3-dB reduction in the in-band phase noise of the LMK03318 device’s outputs. However, enabling the doubler poses the requirement of less than 0.5% duty cycle distortion of its reference input to minimize high spurious signals in the LMK03318’s outputs. If the reference input duty cycle is requirement is not met, the PLL's higher order loop filter components (R3 and C3) can be utilized to suppress the reference input spurs. 10.4.5 Reference Divider (R) The reference (R) divider is a continuous 3-b counter that is present on the primary reference before the smart input MUX of the PLL. The output of the R divider sets the input frequency for the smart input MUX and the auto switch capability of the smart input MUX can then be employed as long as the secondary input frequency is no more than 2000 ppm different from the output of the R divider, which is programmed in R52 for the PLL. 10.4.6 Input Divider (M) The input (M) divider is a continuous 5-b counter that is present after the smart input MUX of the PLL. The output of the M divider sets the PFD frequency to the PLL and should be in the range of 1 MHz to 150 MHz. The M divider is programmed in R53 for the PLL. 10.4.7 Feedback Divider (N) The N divider of the PLL includes fractional compensation and can achieve any fractional denominator (DEN) from 1 to 4,194,303. The integer portion, INT, is the whole part of the N divider value and the fractional portion, NUM / DEN, is the remaining fraction. N, NUM, and DEN are programmed in R58, R59, R60, R61, R62, R63, R64, and R65 for the PLL. The total programmed N divider value, N, is determined by: N = INT + NUM / DEN. The output of the N divider sets the PFD frequency to the PLL and should be in the range of 1 MHz to 150 MHz. 10.4.8 Phase Frequency Detector (PFD) The PFD of the PLL takes inputs from the input divider output and the feedback divider output and produces an output that is dependent on the phase and frequency difference between the two inputs. The allowable range of frequencies at the inputs of the PFD is from 1 MHz to 150 MHz. 10.4.9 Charge Pump The PLL has charge pump slices of 0.4 mA, 0.8 mA, 1.6 mA, or 6.4 mA. These slices can be selected in the following combinations to vary the charge pump current from 0.4 mA to 6.4 mA by programming R57[3-0] for the PLL. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 39 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.4.10 Loop Filter The PLL supports programmable loop bandwidth from 200 Hz to 1 MHz. The loop filter components, R2, C1, R3, C3, can be configured by programming R67, R68, R69 and R70 for the PLL. C2 for the PLL is an external component that is added on the LF pin. When the PLL is configured in the fractional mode, R69.0 should be set to 1 and R118[2-0] should be set to 111. When the PLL is configured in integer mode, R69.0 should be set to 0 and R118[2-0] should be set to 011 for second-order (NOTE: R69 should be set to 00000000) or "111 for thirdorder respectively. When the PLL's loop bandwidth is desired to be set to 200 Hz, R120.0 should be set to 0. Figure 58 shows the loop filter structure of the PLL. It is important to set the PLL to best possible bandwidth to minimize output jitter. A high bandwidth (≥ 100 kHz) provides best input signal tracking and is therefore desired with a clean input reference (clock generator mode). A low bandwidth (≤ 1 kHz) is desired if the input signal quality is unknown (jitter cleaner mode). TI provides the WEBENCH Clock Architect that makes it easy to select the right loop filter components. C2 LF LMK03318 R2 R3 From PFD / Charge Pump >> >> C3 C1 Loop Filter Control R67 R68 R69 R70 Figure 58. Loop Filter Structure of PLL 10.4.11 VCO Calibration The PLL of the LMK03318 includes an LC VCO that is designed using high-Q monolithic inductor to oscillate between 4.8 GHz and 5.4 GHz and has low phase-noise characteristics. The VCO must be calibrated to ensure that the clock outputs deliver optimal phase noise performance. Fundamentally, a VCO calibration establishes an optimal operating point within the tuning range of the VCO. While transparent to the user, the LMK03318 and the host system perform the following steps comprising a VCO calibration sequence: 1. Normal Operation - When the LMK03318 is in normal (operational) mode, the state of the power-down pin (PDN) is high. 2. Entering the reset state - If the user wishes to initialize the selected pin mode default settings (from ROM, EEPROM, or register default) and initiate a VCO calibration sequence, then the host system must place the device in reset via the PDN pin, or via software reset (R12.7) through I2C, or by removing and restoring device power. Pulling the PDN pin low low or setting R12.7 = 0 places the device in the reset state. 3. Exiting the reset state – The device calibrates the VCO either by exiting the device reset state or through the device reset command initiated via the host interface. Exiting the reset state occurs automatically after power is applied and/or the system restores the state of the PDN or R12.7 from the low to high state. Exiting the reset state using the PDN pin causes the selected pin mode defaults to be loaded/reloaded into the device register bank. Invoking software reset via R12.7 does not re-initialize the registers; rather, the device 40 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 retains settings related to the current clock frequency plan. Using this method allows for a VCO calibration for a frequency plan other than the default state (i.e. the device calibrates the VCO based on the settings current register settings). The nominal state of this bit is high. Writing this bit to a low state and then returning it to the high state invokes a device reset without restoring the pin mode. 4. Device stabilization – After exiting the reset state as described in Step 3, the device monitors internal voltages and starts a reset timer. Only after internal voltages are at the correct level and the reset time has expired will the device initiate a VCO calibration. This ensures that the device power supplies and reference inputs have stabilized prior to calibrating the VCO. 5. VCO Calibration - The LMK03318 calibrates the VCO. During the calibration routine, the device mutes output channels configured with their respective auto-mute control enabled, so that they generate no spurious clock signals. After a successful calibration routine, the PLL will lock the VCO to the selected reference input. 10.4.12 Fractional Circuitry The delta-sigma modulator is a key component of the fractional circuitry and is involved in noise shaping for better phase noise and spurs in the band of interest. The order of the delta sigma modulator is selectable from integer mode to third order and can be programmed in R66[1-0] for the PLL. There are also several dithering modes that are also programmed in R66[3-2] for the PLL. 10.4.12.1 Programmable Dithering Levels If used appropriately, dithering may be used to reduce sub-fractional spurs, but if used inappropriately, it can actually create spurs and increase phase noise. Table 5 provides guidelines for the use of dithering based on the fractional denominator, after the fraction is reduced to lowest terms. Table 5. Dithering Recommendations RECOMMENDATION COMMENTS Fractional Numerator = 0 FRACTION Disable Dithering This is often the worst case for spurs, and can actually be turned into the best case by disabling dithering. Performance is then similar to integer mode. Equivalent Denominator < 20 Disable Dithering These fractions are not well randomized and dithering will likely create phase noise and spurs. Equivalent denominator is not divisible by 2 or 3 Disable Dithering There will be no sub-fractional spurs, so dithering is likely not to be very effective. Equivalent denominator > 200 and is divisible by 2 or 3 Consider Dithering Dithering may help reduce the sub-fractional spurs, but understand it may degrade the PLL phase noise. 10.4.12.2 Programmable Delta Sigma Modulator Order The programmable fractional modulator order gives the opportunity to better optimize phase noise and spurs. Theoretically, higher order modulators push out phase noise to farther offsets, as described in Table 6. Table 6. Delta Sigma Modulator Order Recommendations ORDER APPLICATIONS Integer Mode (Order = 0) If the fractional numerator is zero, it is best to run the PLL in integer mode to minimize phase noise and spurs. First Order Modulator When the equivalent fractional denominator is 6 or less, the first order modulator theoretically has lower phase noise and spurs, so it always makes sense in these situations. When the fractional denoninator is between 6 and about 20, consider using the first order modulator because the spurs might be far enough outside the loop bandwidth that they will be filtered. The first order modulator also does not create any sub-fractional spurs or phase noise. Second and Third Order Modulator The choice between 2nd and 3rd order modulator tends to be a little more application specific. If the fractional denominator is not divisible by 3, then the second and third order modulators will have spurs in the same offsets, so the third is generally better for spurs. However, if stronger levels of dithering is used, the third order modulator will create more close-in phase noise than the second order modulator. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 41 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Figure 59 and Figure 60 give an idea of the theoretical impact of the delta sigma modulator order on the shaping of the phase noise and spurs. In terms of phase noise, this is what one would theoretically expect if strong dithering was used for a well-randomized fraction. Dithering can be set to different levels or even disabled and the noise can be eliminated. In terms of spurs, they can change based on fraction, but they will theoretically pushed out to higher phase detector frequencies. However, one must be aware that these are just THEORETICAL graphs and for offsets that are less than 5% of the phase detector frequency, other factors can impact the noise and spurs. In Figure 59, the curves all cross at 1/6th of the phase detector frequency and that this transfer function peaks at half of the phase detector frequency, which is assumed to be well outside the loop bandwidth. Figure 60 shows the impact of the phase detector frequency on the modulator noise. -50 Theoretical Gain for Noise and Spurs (dB) -60 -70 -80 -90 -100 -110 -120 -130 -140 1st Order Modulator 2nd Order Modulator 3rd Order Modulator -150 1x106 2x106 5x106 1x107 2x107 Offset (Hz) 5x107 1x108 2x108 Figure 59. Theoretical Delta Sigma Noise Shaping for a 100 MHz Phase Detector Frequency -50 Theoretical Gain for Noise and Spurs (dB) -60 -70 -80 -90 -100 -110 -120 -130 Fpd=10MHz Fpd=100 MHz Fpd=200 MHz -140 -150 1x106 2x106 5x106 1x107 2x107 Offset (Hz) 5x107 1x108 2x108 Figure 60. Theoretical Delta Sigma Noise Shaping for 3rd Order Modulator 10.4.13 Post Divider Each PLL has a post divider that supports divide-by 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 from the VCO frequency and distributed to the output section by programming R56[4-2] for PLL and R71[4-2] for PLL2. 42 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.4.14 High-Speed Output MUX The output section is made up of four high-speed output MUX’s. Each of the four MUX able to select between primary reference, secondary reference or the divided PLLclock by programming R37[7-6], R39[7-6], R41[7-6], and R43[7-6]. Each of the four MUX’s distributes individually to outputs 4, 5, 6, 7. When reference doubler is enabled and any output MUX selects that reference input, the output frequency will be the same as the reference frequency (non-doubled) but the output phase could be the same or complementary of the reference input. 10.4.15 High-Speed Output Divider There are six high-speed output dividers and each supports divide values of 1 to 256. Outputs 0 and 1 share an output divider, as well as outputs 2 and 3. Outputs 4, 5, 6, 7 have their own individual output dividers. The divide values are programmed in R33, R36, R38, R40, R42, and R44. These output dividers also support coarse frequency margining for all output divide values greater than 8 and can be enabled on any output channel by setting the appropriate bit in R24 to a 1. In such a use case, a dynamic change in the output divider value via I2C ensures that there are no glitches at the output irrespective of when the change is initiated. Depending on the VCO frequency and output divide values, as low as a 5% change can be initiated in the output frequency. An example case of coarse frequency margining on an output is shown in Figure 61. VCO Clock Output 1 (output divider = 12) Output 2 (original divider = 12 new devider = 13) Delay from auto sync after new divider (no glitch) USER ACTION: Output 2 divider change from divide-by-12 to divide-by-13 Output 3 (original divider = 12 new divider = 13) Delay from auto sync after new divider (no glitch and completes active pulse before change) USER ACTION: Output 3 divider change from divide-by-12 to divide-by-13 Figure 61. Simplified Diagram for Coarse Frequency Margining 10.4.16 High-Speed Clock Outputs Each output can be configured as AC-LVPECL, AC-LVDS, AC-CML, HCSL or LVCMOS by programming R31, R32, R34, R35, R37, R39, R41, and R43. Each output has the option to be muted or not, in case the source from which it is derived becomes invalid, by programming R22. An invalid source could be a primary or secondary reference that is no longer present or any PLL that is unlocked. When outputs are to be muted, R20 and R21 must each be programmed to 111111111. Outputs 0 and 1 share an output supply (VDDO_01), as well as outputs 2 and 3 (VDDO_23). Outputs 4, 5, 6, 7 have individual output supplies (VDDO_4, VDDO_5, VDDO_6, VDDO_7). Each output supply can be independently set to 1.8 V, 2.5 V or 3.3 V. When a particular output is desired to be disabled, the bits [5:0] in the corresponding output control register (R31, R32, R34, R35, R37, R39, R41 or R43) must be set to 000000. If any of outputs 4, 5, 6, and 7 and their output dividers are disabled; their corresponding supplies can be connected to GND. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 43 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com The AC-LVDS, AC-CML, and AC-LVPECL output structure is given in Figure 62 where the tail currents can be programmed to either 4 mA, 6 mA, or 8 mA to generate output voltage swings that are compatible with LVDS, CML or LVPECL, respectively. Since this output structure is GND referenced, the output supplies can be operated from 1.8 V, 2.5 V or 3.3 V and offer lower power dissipation compared to traditional LVDS, CML, or LVPECL structures without any impact on jitter performance or other AC or DC specifications. Interfacing to LVDS, CML or LVPECL receivers are done with just an external AC-coupling capacitor for each output. No source termination is needed since the on-chip termination is automatically enabled when selecting AC-LVDS, AC-CML, or AC-LVPECL for good impedance matching to 50 Ω interconnects. 1.8 V, 2.5 V, 3.3 V LDO 4 mA P P N N I1 Output Current can be programmed to 4 mA, 6 mA, or 8 mA (I1 + I2) IN OUT INb 0, 2, 4 mA P P N N I2 OUTb Figure 62. Structure of AC-LVDS, AC-CML, and AC-LVPECL Output Stage The HCSL output structure is open drain and can be direct coupled or AC coupled to HCSL receivers with appropriate termination scheme. This output strcture supports either on-chip 50 Ω termination or off-chip 50 Ω termination. The on-chip 50 Ω termination is provided primarily for convenience when driving short traces. In the case of driving long traces possibly through a connector, the on-chip termination should be disabled and a 50 Ω to GND termination at the receiver should be implemented. The output supplies can be operated from 1.8 V, 2.5 V or 3.3 V without any impact on jitter performance or other AC or DC specifications. The LVCMOS outputs on each side (P and N) can be configured individually to be complementary or in-phase or can be turned off (high output impedance). The output supplies need to be operated from 1.8 V only. In case 3.3V LVCMOS outputs are needed, STATUS1 and/or STATUS0 can be configured as 3.3-V LVCMOS outputs. The following figures show recommendations for interfacing between LMK03318’s high-speed clock outputs and LVCMOS, LVPECL, LVDS, CML, and HCSL receivers respectively. NOTE If 1.8-V LVCMOS signals from the high-speed clock outputs are desired to be interfaced with a 3.3-V LVCMOS receiver, a level-shifter like LSF0101 must be used to convert the 1.8-V LVCMOS signal to a 3.3-V LVCMOS signal. 44 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 LVCMOS 1.8-V LVCMOS Receiver LMK03318 Figure 63. Interfacing LMK03318’s 1.8-V LVCMOS Output With 1.8-V LVCMOS Receiver VrefA = 1.8 V VrefB = 3.3 V LVCMOS LMK03318 3.3-V LVCMOS Receiver LSF0101 Figure 64. Interfacing LMK03318’s 1.8-V LVCMOS Output With 3.3-V LVCMOS Receiver LMK03318 LVPECL Receiver AC-LVPECL 50 50 VDD_IN - 2 Figure 65. Interfacing LMK03318’s AC-LVPECL Output With LVPECL Receiver LMK03318 AC-LVDS 100 LVDS Receiver Figure 66. Interfacing LMK03318’s AC-LVDS Output with LVDS Receiver 50 LMK03318 CML Receiver AC-CML 50 Figure 67. Interfacing LMK03318’s AC-CML Output With CML Receiver 33 LMK03318 (optional) HCSL Receiver HCSL 33 (optional) 50 50 Figure 68. Interfacing LMK03318’s Output With HCSL Receiver Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 45 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.4.17 Output Synchronization All output dividers and the PLL post divider can be synchronized using the active-low SYNCN signal. This signal can come from the GPIO0 pin (in soft pin mode only) or from R12.6. The most common way to execute the output synchronization is to toggle the GPIO0 pin. When R56.1 is set to 1, to enable synchronization of outputs that is derived from the PLL, and GPIO0 pin is asserted (VGPIO0 ≤ VIL), the corresponding output driver(s) are muted and divider is reset. NOTE Output-to-output skew specification can only be assured when PLL post divider is greater than 2 and after an output synchronization event. The latency to reset VCO divider is a sum of 1. 2 to 3 negative edge of output clock cycles of the largest divided value + “x” nano seconds of asynchronous delay + 2 to 3 VCO clock cycle. 2. If SYNCN happens after rising but before negative edge, sync delay is less 3 clock cycle and closer to 2 clock cycle. 3. The latency is deterministic and its variation is no more than 1 VCO clock cycle and an example scenario is illustrated in Figure 62. Table 7. Output Channel Synchronization GPIO0 / R12.6 OUTPUT DIVIDER AND DRIVER STATE 0 Output driver(s) is tri-stated and divider is reset 1 Normal output driver/divider operation as configured Minimum SYNC pulse width = 3 negative clock edge of slowest output clock cycle + “x” nano second of prop delay + 3 VCO clock cycle. The synchronization feature is particularly helpful in systems with multiple LMK03318 devices. If SYNCN is released simultaneously for all devices, the total remaining output delay variation is ±1 VCO clock cycles for all devices configured to identical output mux settings. Output enable/disable events are synchronous to minimize glitch/runt pulses. In Soft Pin Mode, the SYNCN control can also be used to disable any outputs to prevent output clocks from being distributed to down-stream devices, such as DSPs or FPGAs, until they are configured and ready to accept the incoming clock. PLL Clock or Reference Clock 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 One post-divider clock cycle uncertainty, of when the output turns on for one device in one particular configuration GPIO0 or R12.6 OUT0 Possibility (A) Output Low OUT0 Possibility (B) Output Low Figure 69. SYNCN to Output Delay Variation 10.4.18 Status Outputs The device vitals such as input signal quality, smart MUX input selection, PLL loss of lock can be monitored by reading device registers or by monitoring the status pins, STATUS1 and STATUS0. R27 and R28 allow customizing which of the vitals are mapped out to these two pins. Table 7 lists the events that can be mapped to each status pin and which can also be read in the register space. The polarity of the events mapped to the status pins can be selected by programming R15. 46 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 A logic-high interrupt output (INTR) can also be selected on either status pins to indicate interrupt status from any of the device vitals listed in R16. In order to use this feature, R17.0 should be set to 1, R14[4:2] must be set to 111, and R14.0 must be set to 1. The interrupts listed in R16 can be combined in an AND or OR functionality by programming R17.1. If interrupts stemming from particular device vitals are to be ignored, the appropriate bits in R14 should be programmed as needed. The contents of R16 can be read back at any time irrespective of whether the INTR function is chosen in either status pins as long as R17.0 = 1 and the contents of R16 are selfcleared once the readback is complete. There also exists a “real-time” interrupt register, R13, which indicate interrupt status from the device vitals irrespective of the state of R17.0. The contents of R13 can be also read back at any time and are self-cleared once the readback is complete. 10.4.18.1 Loss of Reference The primary and secondary references can be monitored for their input signal quality and appropriate register bits and status outputs, if enabled, are flagged if a loss of signal event is encountered. For differential inputs, a “loss of signal” event occurs when the differential input swing is lower than the threshold as programmed in R25[3-2] for secondary reference and in R25[1-0] for primary reference. For LVCMOS inputs, a loss of signal event can be triggered based on either a minimum threshold, programmed in R25[3-2] for secondary reference and in R25[1-0] for primary reference, or a minimum slew rate of 0.3 V/ns, rising edge or falling edge or both being monitored based on selections programmed in R25[7-6] for secondary reference and in R25[5-4] for primary reference. 10.4.18.2 Loss of Lock The PLL’s loss of lock detection circuit is a digital circuit that detects any frequency error, even a single cycle slip. The PLL unlock is detected when a certain number of cycle slips have been exceeded, at which point the counter is reset. If the loss of lock is intended to toggle a system reset, an RC filter on the status output, which is programmed to indicate loss of lock, is recommended to avoid rare cycle slips from triggering an entire system reset. Table 8. Device Vitals Selection Matrix for STATUS[1:0] NUMBER SIGNAL 0 PRIREF Loss of Signal (LOS) 1 SECREF Loss of Signal (LOS) 2 PLL Loss of Lock (LOL) 3 PLL R Divider, divided by 2 (when R Divider is not bypassed) 4 PLL N Divider, divided by 2 5 RESERVED 6 RESERVED 7 RESERVED 8 PLL VCO Calibration Active (CAL) 9 RESERVED 10 Interrupt (INTR) 11 PLL M Divider, divided by 2 (when M Divider is not bypassed) 12 RESERVED 13 EEPROM Active 14 PLL Secondary to Primary Switch in Automatic Mode 15 RESERVED When the status pins are programmed as 3.3-V LVCMOS PLL clock outputs with fast output rise/fall time setting, they support up to 200 MHz operation and each output can independently be programmed to different frequencies. Each output has the option to be muted or not, in case the PLL from which it is derived loses lock, by programming R23 and when muted, the output is held at a static state depending on the programmed output type/polarity. in a loss-of-lock event. In order to reduce coupling onto the high-speed outputs, the output rise/fall time can be modified in R49 to support slower slew rates. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 47 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com NOTE When either status pin is set as a 3.3-V LVCMOS output, there is fairly significant mixing of these output frequencies into the high-speed outputs, especially outputs 4, 5, 6, 7. If 3.3-V LVCMOS outputs are desired, proper care should be taken during frequency planning with the LMK03318 to ensure that the outputs, required with low jitter, are selected from either output 0, 1, 2, or 3. For best jitter performance, it is recommended to use both status pins to generate complementary 3.3-V LVCMOS outputs at any time. 10.5 Device Functional Modes 10.5.1 Interface and Control The host (DSP, Microcontroller, FPGA, etc) configures and monitors the LMK03318 via the I2C port. The host reads and writes to a collection of control/status bits called the register map. The device blocks can be controlled and monitored via a specific grouping of bits located within the register file. The host controls and monitors certain device-wide critical parameters directly via register control/status bits. In the absence of the host, the LMK03318 can be configured to operate in pin-mode either from its on-chip ROM or EEPROM depending on the state of HW_SW_CTRL pin. The EEPROM or ROM arrays are automatically copied to the device registers upon powerup. The user has the flexibility to re-write the contents of EEPROM from the SRAM up to a 100 times but the contents of ROM cannot be re-written. Within the device registers, there are certain bits that have read/write access. Other bits are read-only (an attempt to write to a read only bit will not change the state of the bit). Certain device registers and bits are reserved meaning that they must not be changed from their default reset state. Figure 70 shows interface and control blocks within LMK03318 and the arrows refer to read access from and write access to the different embedded memories (ROM, EEPROM, SRAM). 48 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Device Functional Modes (continued) ROM (hard pin mode) 1 of 64 images Reg89 7 Reg88 7 Reg87 7 Reg86 7 Reg3 7 Reg2 7 Reg1 7 Reg 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 STATUS0 STATUS1 Device Registers PDN Control/ Status Pins Reg200 7 Reg199 7 Reg29 7 Reg28 7 GPIO5 GPIO4 Device Control And Status GPIO3 GPIO2 Reg3 7 Reg2 7 Reg1 7 Reg 0 7 GPIO1 GPIO0 I2C Port SCL 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Device Hardware SDA HW_SW_CTRL Reg89 7 Reg88 7 Reg87 7 Reg86 7 Reg3 7 Reg2 7 Reg1 7 Reg 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Reg89 7 Reg88 7 Reg87 7 Reg86 7 Reg3 7 Reg2 7 Reg1 7 Reg 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EEPROM (soft pin mode) 1 of 6 images SRAM (soft pin mode) 1 of 6 images Figure 70. LMK03318 Interface and Control Block Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 49 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.6 Programming 10.6.1 I2C Serial Interface The I2C port on the LMK03318 works as a slave device and supports both the 100 kHz standard mode and 400 kHz fast-mode operations. Fast mode imposes a glitch tolerance requirement on the control signals. Therefore, the input receivers ignore pulses of less than 50-ns duration. The I2C timing is given in I2C-Compatible Interface Characteristics (SDA, SCL). The timing diagram is given in Figure 71. STOP START ACK tW(SCLL) tW(SCLH) STOP tf(SM) tr(SM) ~ ~ VIH(SM) SCL VIL(SM) ~ ~ th(START) tr(SM) tSU(SDATA) th(SDATA) tSU(START) tSU(STOP) tf(SM) tBUS ~ ~ ~ ~ VIH(SM) SDA VIL(SM) ~ ~ Figure 71. I2C Timing Diagram In an I2C bus system, the LMK03318 acts as a slave device and is connected to the serial bus (data bus SDA and clock bus SCL). These are accessed via a 7-bit slave address transmitted as part of an I2C packet. Only the device with a matching slave address responds to subsequent I2C commands. In soft pin mode, the LMK03318 allows up to three unique slave devices to occupy the I2C bus based on the pin strapping of GPIO1 (tied to VDD_DIG, GND or VIM). The device slave address is 10100xx (the two LSBs are determined by the GPIO1 pin). NOTE The first I2C transaction, after power cycling LMK03318, should be ignored. During the data transfer through the I2C interface, one clock pulse is generated for each data bit transferred. The data on the SDA line must be stable during the high period of the clock. The high or low state of the data line can change only when the clock signal on the SCL line is low. The start data transfer condition is characterized by a high-to-low transition on the SDA line while SCL is high. The stop data transfer condition is characterized by a low-to-high transition on the SDA line while SCL is high. The start and stop conditions are always initiated by the master. Every byte on the SDA line must be eight bits long. Each byte must be followed by an acknowledge bit and bytes are sent MSB first. The I2C register structure of the LMK03318 is shown in Figure 72. I2C PROTOCOL 7 1 8 8 W/R REGISTER ADDRESS DATA BYTE A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 I2C ADDRESS Figure 72. I2C Register Structure The acknowledge bit (A) or non-acknowledge bit (A’) is the 9th bit attached to any 8-bit data byte and is always generated by the receiver to inform the transmitter that the byte has been received (when A = 0) or not (when A’ = 0). A = 0 is done by pulling the SDA line low during the 9th clock pulse and A’ = 0 is done by leaving the SDA line high during the 9th clock pulse. 50 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Programming (continued) The I2C master initiates the data transfer by asserting a start condition which initiates a response from all slave devices connected to the serial bus. Based on the 8-bit address byte sent by the master over the SDA line (consisting of the 7-bit slave address (MSB first) and an R/W’ bit), the device whose address corresponds to the transmitted address responds by sending an acknowledge bit. All other devices on the bus remain idle while the selected device waits for data transfer with the master. After the data transfer has occurred, stop conditions are established. In write mode, the master asserts a stop condition to end data transfer during the 10th clock pulse following the acknowledge bit for the last data byte from the slave. In read mode, the master receives the last data byte from the slave but does not pull SDA low during the 9th clock pulse. This is known as a non-acknowledge bit. By receiving the non-acknowledge bit, the slave knows the data transfer is finished and enters the idle mode. The master then takes the data line low during the low period before the 10th clock pulse, and high during the 10th clock pulse to assert a stop condition. A generic transation is shown in Figure 73. 1 S 7 Slave Address 1 R/W MSB LSB S Start Condition Sr Repeated Start Condition 1 A 8 Data Byte MSB 1 A 1 P LSB R/W 1 = Read (Rd) from slave; 0 = Write (Wr) to slave A Acknowledge (ACK = 0 and NACK = 1) P Stop Condition Master to Slave Transmission Slave to Master Transmission Figure 73. Generic Programming Sequence The LMK03318 I2C interface supports “Block Register Write/Read”, “Read/Write SRAM”, and “Read/Write EEPROM” operations. For “Block Register Write/Read” operations, the I2C master can individually access addressed registers that are made of an 8-bit data byte. The offset of the indexed register is encoded in R10 and part of the EEPROM, as described in Table 9 below. To change the most significant 5 bits of the I2C slave address from its default value, the EEPROM byte 11 can be re-written with the desired value and R10 provides a read-back of the new slave address. Table 9. I2C Slave Address Operating Mode R10.7 R10.6 R10.5 R10.4 R10.3 Hard pin mode 1 0 1 0 0 Soft pin mode 1 0 1 0 0 R10.2 R10.1 0 0 Controlled by GPIO1 state. GPIO1 R10.2, R10.1 0 0, 0 VIM 0, 1 1 1, 1 10.6.2 Block Register Write The I2C Block Register Write transaction is illustrated in Figure 74 and consists of the following sequence: 1. Master issues a Start Condition. 2. Master writes the 7-bit Slave Address following by a Write bit. 3. Master writes the 8-bit Register address as the CommandCode of the programming sequence. 4. Master writes one or more data bytes each of which should be acknowledged by the slave. The slave increments the internal register address after each byte. 5. Master issues a Stop Condition to terminate the transaction. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 51 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 1 S www.ti.com 7 Slave Address 8 Data Byte 0 1 Wr 1 A 1 A ... 8 CommandCode 1 A 8 Data Byte N-1 1 A 1 P Figure 74. Block Register Write Programming Sequence 10.6.3 Block Register Read The I2C Block Register Read transaction is illustrated in Figure 75 and consists of the following sequence: 1. Master issues a Start Condition. 2. Master writes the 7-bit Slave Address followed by a Write bit. 3. Master writes the 8-bit Register address as the CommandCode of the programming sequence. 4. Master issues a Repeated Start Condition. 5. Master writes the 7-bit Slave Address following by a Read bit. 6. Slave returns one or more data bytes as long as the Master continues to acknowledge them. The slave increments the internal register address after each byte. 7. Master issues a Stop Condition to terminate the transaction. 1 S 7 Slave Address 8 Data Byte 0 1 Wr 1 A 1 A 8 CommandCode 1 A ... 1 Sr 7 Slave Address 8 Data Byte N-1 1 Rd 1 A 1 A 1 P Figure 75. Block Register Read Programming Sequence 10.6.4 Write SRAM The on-chip SRAM is a volatile, shadow memory array used to temporarily store register data, and is intended only for programming the non Volatile EEPROM array with one or more device start-up configuration settings (pages). The SRAM has the identical data format as the EEPROM map. The register configuration data can be transferred to the SRAM array through special memory access registers in the register map. The SRAM is made up of a base memory array and 6 pages of identical memory arrays. In order to successfully program the SRAM, the complete base array and at least one page should be written. The following details the programming sequence to transfer the device registers into the appropriate SRAM page. 1. Program the device registers to match a desired setting. 2. Write R145[3:0] with a valid SRAM page (0 to 5) to commit the current register data. 3. Write a 1 to R137.6. This ensures that the device registers are copied to the desired SRAM page. 4. If another device setting is desired to be written to a different SRAM page, repeat steps 1-3 and select an unused SRAM page. The SRAM can also be written with particular values according to the following programming sequence. 1. Write the most significant 8th bit of the SRAM address in R139.0 and write the least significant 8 bits in R140. 2. Write the desired data byte in R142 in the same I2C transaction and this data byte will be written to the address specified in the step above. Any additional access that is part of the same transaction will cause the SRAM address to be incremented and a write will take place to the next SRAM address. Access to SRAM will terminate at the end of current I2C transaction. 3. Steps 1 and 2 need to be followed to change EEPROM bytes 11 and 12. Byte 11 denotes the I2C slave address of LMK03318 and Byte 12 denotes an 8-b user space that can be utilized as a device identifier among multiple LMK03318 instances with different EEPROM images. 52 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 NOTE It is possible to increment SRAM address incorrectly when 2 successive accesses are made to R140. 10.6.5 Write EEPROM The on-chip EEPROM is a non-volatile memory array used to permanently store register data for one or more device start-up configuration settings (pages), which can be selected to initialize registers upon power-up or POR. There are a total of 6 independent EEPROM pages of which each page is selected by the 3-level GPIO[3:2] pins, and each page is comprised of bits shown in the EEPROM Map. The transfer must first happen to the corresponding SRAM page and then to the EEPROM page. During “EEPROM write”, R137.2 is a 1 and the EEPROM contents cannot be accessed. The following details the programming sequence to transfer the entire contents of SRAM to EEPROM: 1. Make sure the Write SRAM procedure (Write SRAM) was done to commit the register settings to the SRAM page(s) with start-up configurations intended for programming to the EEPROM array. 2. Write “0xEA” to R144. This provides basic protection from inadvertent programming of EEPROM. 3. Write a 1 to R137.0. This programs the entire SRAM contents to EEPROM. Once completed, the contents in R136 will increment by 1. R136 contains the total number of EEPROM programming cycles that are successfully completed. 4. Write "0x00" to R144 to protect against inadvertent programming of EEPROM. 5. If an EEPROM write is unsuccessful, a readback of R137.5 results in a 1. In this case, the device will not function correctly and will be locked up. To unlock the device for correct operation, a new EEPROM write sequence should be initiated and successfully completed. 10.6.6 Read SRAM The contents of the SRAM can be read out, one word at a time, starting with that of the requested address. Following details the programming sequence for an SRAM read by address. 1. Write the most significant 9th bit of the SRAM address in R139.0 and write the least significant 8 bits of the SRAM address in R140. 2. The SRAM data located at the address specified in the step above can be obtained by reading R142 in the same I2C transaction. Any additional access that is part of the same transaction will cause the SRAM address to be incremented and a read will take place of the next SRAM address. Access to SRAM will terminate at the end of current I2C transaction. NOTE It is possible to increment SRAM address incorrectly when 2 successive accesses are made to R140. 10.6.7 Read EEPROM The contents of the EEPROM can be read out, one word at a time, starting with that of the requested address. Following details the programming sequence for an EEPROM read by address. 1. Write the most significant 9th bit of the EEPROM address in R139.0 and write the least significant 8 bits of the EEPROM address in R140. 2. The EEPROM data located at the address specified in the step above can be obtained by reading R141 in the same I2C transaction. Any additional access that is part of the same transaction will cause the EEPROM address to be incremented and a read will take place of the next EEPROM address. Access to EEPROM will terminate at the end of current I2C transaction. NOTE It is possible to increment EEPROM address incorrectly when 2 successive accesses are made to R140. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 53 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.6.8 Read ROM The contents of the ROM can be read out, one word at a time, starting with that of the requested address. Following details the programming sequence of a ROM read by address. 1. Write the most significant 11th, 10th, 9th, and 8th bit of the ROM address in R139[3-0] and write the least significant 8 bits of the ROM address in R140. 2. The ROM data located at the address specified in the step above can be obtained by reading R143 in the same I2C transaction. Any additional access that is part of the same transaction will cause the ROM address to be incremented and a read will take place of the next ROM address. Access to ROM will terminate at the end of current I2C transaction. 54 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.6.9 Default Device Configurations in EEPROM and ROM Tables 10-13 show the device default configurations stored in the on-chip EEPROM. Tables 14-18 show the device default configurations stored in the on-chip ROM. Table 10. Default EEPROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 0) – Input and Status Configuration GPIO[3 :2] PRI INPUT (MHz) PRI TYPE PRI DOUBLER SEC INPUT (MHz) SEC TYPE XO INT LOAD (pF) SEC DOUBLER STATUS1 MUX STATUS0 MUX PREDIV DIV STATUS1 / STATUS1 / STATUS0 STATUS0 RISE / FREQ FALL TIME (MHz) (ns) VIM, VIM 25 LVDS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled LOL Disable n/a n/a n/a n/a 00 156.25 LVPECL Disabled 156.25 LVCMOS n/a Disabled LOL LOR_ PRI n/a n/a n/a n/a 0, VIM 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled PLL PLL 4 50 25 2.1 01 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled PLL PLL 4 50 25 2.1 10 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 LVPECL n/a Enabled (LOR_PRI)' (LOL)' n/a n/a n/a n/a 1, VIM 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled (LOR_PRI)' (LOL)' n/a n/a n/a n/a 11 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled (LOR_PRI)' (LOL)' n/a n/a n/a n/a Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 55 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 11. Default EEPROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 0) – PLL Configuration (1) GPIO[3 :2] PLL INPUT PLL INPUT MUX (MHz) PLL TYPE PLL R DIV PLL M DIV PLL N DIV PLL N DIV INT PLL N DIV NUM PLL N DIV DEN PLL FRAC ORDER PLL FRAC DITHER PLL VCO (MHz) PLL P DIV VIM, VIM REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 102 102 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 8 00 REFSEL 156.25 Clock Gen Integer 1 2 66 66 0 1 n/a Disabled 5156.25 4 0, VIM REFSEL 100 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 4 01 REFSEL 100 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 4 10 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 4 1, VIM REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 4 11 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 102 102 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 3 (1) 56 When PLL is set as an integer-based clock generator, external loop filter component, C2, should be 3.3 nF and loop bandwidth is around 400 kHz. When PLL is set as a fractional-based clock generator, external loop filter component, C2, should be 33 nF and loop bandwidth is around 400 kHz. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Table 12. Default EEPROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 0) – Outputs [0-3] Configuration OUT0-1 FREQ (MHz) GPIO[3:2] OUT0-1 DIVIDER VIM, VIM n/a n/a 00 8 161.1328125 0, VIM 8 156.25 01 8 10 8 1, VIM 11 OUT0 TYPE OUT2-3 FREQ (MHz) OUT1 TYPE OUT2-3 DIVIDER OUT2 TYPE OUT3 TYPE Disable Disable n/a n/a Disable Disable LVPECL LVPECL 8 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL LVPECL LVPECL 8 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 10 125 LVPECL LVPECL 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 8 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 8 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 8 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 17 100 HCSL HCSL 17 100 HCSL HCSL Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 57 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 13. Default EEPROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 0) – Outputs [4-7] Configuration OUT4 FREQ (MHz) OUT4 MUX SELECT OUT4 TYPE OUT5 DIV OUT5 FREQ (MHz) OUT5 MUX SELECT OUT5 TYPE OUT6 DIV 3 212.5 PLL LVPECL 8 161.1328 125 3 212.5 PLL LVPECL LVPECL 8 161.1328 125 PLL PLL 0, VIM 8 156.25 01 10 125 PLL LVPECL 10 125 PLL LVPECL 10 125 10 50 25 PLL LVPECL 50 1, VIM 11 8 156.25 PLL LVPECL 17 100 PLL LVDS GPIO [3:2] OUT4 DIV VIM, VIM 00 58 OUT6 FREQ (MHz) OUT6 MUX SELECT OUT6 TYPE OUT7 DIV OUT7 FREQ (MHz) OUT7 MUX SELECT OUT7 TYPE 6 106.25 PLL LVPECL LVPECL 8 161.1328 125 6 106.25 PLL LVPECL LVPECL 8 161.1328 125 PLL PLL LVPECL PLL LVPECL 10 125 PLL LVPECL 10 125 PLL LVPECL 10 125 PLL LVPECL PLL LVPEC 10 125 PLL 25 PLL LVPECL 50 LVPECL 25 PLL LVPECL 50 25 PLL LVPECL 50 25 PLL LVPECL n/a n/a n/a Disable 50 25 PLL LVPECL 1 25 SEC LVDS n/a n/a n/a Disable 17 100 PLL LVCMOS Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Table 14. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Input Configuration GPIO[5:0] (decimal) PRI INPUT (MHz) PRI TYPE PRI DOUBLER SEC INPUT (MHz) SEC TYPE XO INT LOAD (pF) SEC DOUBLER 0 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 1 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 2 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 3 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 4 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 5 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 6 30.72 LVCMOS Disabled 30.72 XTAL 9 Disabled 7 19.2 LVCMOS Disabled 19.2 XTAL 9 Disabled 8 10 LVCMOS Disabled 10 XTAL 9 Disabled 9 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 10 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 11 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 12 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 13 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 14 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 15 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 16 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 17 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 18 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 19 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 20 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 21 19.44 LVCMOS Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled 22 38.88 LVCMOS Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled 23 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 24 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 25 19.44 LVCMOS Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled 26 38.88 LVCMOS Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled 27 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL n/a Enabled 28 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL n/a Enabled 29 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 30 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 31 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL n/a Enabled 32 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 LVCMOS n/a Enabled 33 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 59 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 14. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Input Configuration (continued) GPIO[5:0] (decimal) 60 PRI INPUT (MHz) PRI TYPE 34 50 LVCMOS 35 19.44 LVCMOS 36 38.88 LVCMOS 37 25 38 50 39 PRI DOUBLER SEC INPUT (MHz) SEC TYPE XO INT LOAD (pF) Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 19.44 LVCMOS Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled 40 38.88 LVCMOS Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled 41 19.44 LVCMOS Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled 42 38.88 LVCMOS Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled 43 19.44 LVCMOS Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled 44 38.88 LVCMOS Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled 45 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 46 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 47 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 48 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 49 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 50 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 51 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 52 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 53 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 54 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 55 19.44 LVCMOS Disabled 19.44 XTAL 9 Disabled 56 38.88 LVCMOS Disabled 38.88 XTAL 9 Disabled 57 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 58 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 59 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 60 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 61 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled 62 50 LVCMOS Enabled 50 XTAL 9 Enabled 63 25 LVCMOS Enabled 25 XTAL 9 Enabled Submit Documentation Feedback SEC DOUBLER Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Table 15. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Status Configuration GPIO[5:0] (decimal) STATUS1 MUX STATUS0 MUX STATUS1 PREDIV STATUS1 DIV STATUS1 FREQ (MHz) STATUS1 RISE/FALL TIME (ns) STATUS0 PREDIV STATUS0 DIV STATUS0 FREQ (MHz) STATUS0 RISE/FALL TIME (ns) 0 LOL PLL n/a n/a n/a n/a 5 20 50 2.1 1 LOL PLL n/a n/a n/a n/a 5 40 25 2.1 2 LOL LOR_PRI n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 3 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 4 LOL LOR_PRI n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 5 PLL PLL 5 40 25 2.1 5 40 25 2.1 6 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 7 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 8 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 9 PLL LOL 4 51 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 10 PLL LOL 4 51 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 11 PLL LOL 5 30 33.3333 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 12 PLL LOL 5 30 33.3333 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 13 PLL LOL 4 51 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 14 PLL LOL 4 51 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 15 PLL LOL 4 51 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 16 PLL LOL 4 51 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 17 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 18 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 19 PLL LOL 5 40 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 20 PLL LOL 5 40 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 21 PLL LOL 5 40 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 22 PLL LOL 5 40 25 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 23 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 24 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 25 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 26 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 27 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 28 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 29 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 30 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 31 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 61 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 15. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Status Configuration (continued) 62 GPIO[5:0] (decimal) STATUS1 MUX STATUS0 MUX STATUS1 PREDIV STATUS1 DIV STATUS1 FREQ (MHz) STATUS1 RISE/FALL TIME (ns) STATUS0 PREDIV STATUS0 DIV STATUS0 FREQ (MHz) STATUS0 RISE/FALL TIME (ns) 32 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 33 PLL LOL 5 15 66.6666 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 34 PLL LOL 5 15 66.6666 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 35 PLL LOL 5 15 66.6666 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 36 PLL LOL 5 15 66.6666 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 37 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 38 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 39 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 40 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 41 PLL LOL 4 32 38.88 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 42 PLL LOL 4 32 38.88 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 43 PLL LOL 4 32 38.88 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 44 PLL LOL 4 32 38.88 2.1 n/a n/a n/a n/a 45 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 46 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 47 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 48 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 49 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 50 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 51 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 52 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 53 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 54 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 55 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 56 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 57 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 58 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 59 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 60 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 61 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 62 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 63 LOR_PRI LOL n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Table 16. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) – PLL Configuration (1) GPIO[5:0] (decimal) PLL IN MUX PLL IN (MHz) PLL TYPE PLL R DIV PLL M DIV PLL N DIV PLL N DIV INT PLL N DIV NUM PLL N DIV DEN PLL FRAC ORDER PLL FRAC DITHER PLL VCO (MHz) PLL P DIV 0 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 5 1 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 5 2 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 5 3 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 4 4 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 5 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 6 REFSEL 30.72 Jitter Cleaner Integer 1 24 3840 3840 0 1 n/a Disabled 4915.2 4 7 REFSEL 19.2 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 256 256 0 1 n/a Disabled 4915.2 4 8 REFSEL 10 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 491.52 491 1300000 2500000 Third Enabled 4915.2 4 9 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 102 102 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 8 10 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 51 51 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 8 11 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 12 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 13 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 102 102 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 3 14 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 51 51 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 3 15 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 102 102 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 3 16 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 51 51 0 1 n/a Disabled 5100 3 17 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 18 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 19 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 20 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 21 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 257.2016461 257 157536 781250 Third Enabled 5000 8 22 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 128.600823 128 469393 781250 Third Enabled 5000 8 23 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 24 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 25 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 257.2016461 257 157536 781250 Third Enabled 5000 2 26 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 128.600823 128 469393 781250 Third Enabled 5000 2 27 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 28 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 29 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 30 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 (1) When PLL is set as an integer-based clock generator, external loop filter component, C2, should be 3.3nF and loop bandwidth is around 400kHz. When PLL is set as a fractional-based clock generator, external loop filter component, C2, should be 33nF and loop bandwidth is around 400kHz. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 63 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 16. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) – PLL Configuration(1) (continued) GPIO[5:0] (decimal) PLL IN MUX PLL IN (MHz) PLL TYPE PLL R DIV PLL M DIV PLL N DIV PLL N DIV INT PLL N DIV NUM PLL N DIV DEN PLL FRAC ORDER PLL FRAC DITHER PLL VCO (MHz) PLL P DIV 31 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 32 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 33 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 34 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 35 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 257.2016461 257 157536 781250 Third Enabled 5000 8 36 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 128.600823 128 469393 781250 Third Enabled 5000 8 37 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 38 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 39 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 257.2016461 257 157536 781250 Third Enabled 5000 8 40 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 128.600823 128 469393 781250 Third Enabled 5000 8 41 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 256 256 0 1 n/a Disabled 4976.64 8 42 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 128 128 0 1 n/a Disabled 4976.64 8 43 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 256 256 0 1 n/a Disabled 4976.64 8 44 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 128 128 0 1 n/a Disabled 4976.64 8 45 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 5 46 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 5 47 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 48 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 49 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 50 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 51 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 106.25 106 1000000 4000000 First Enabled 5312.5 2 52 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 53.125 53 500000 4000000 First Enabled 5312.5 2 53 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 103.125 103 500000 4000000 First Enabled 5156.25 8 54 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 51.5625 51 2250000 4000000 First Enabled 5156.25 8 55 REFSEL 19.44 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 265.2391976 265 597994 2500000 Third Enabled 5156.25 8 56 REFSEL 38.88 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 132.6195988 132 1548997 2500000 Third Enabled 5156.25 8 57 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 58 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 2 59 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 60 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 61 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 62 REFSEL 50 Clock Gen Integer 1 1 50 50 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 63 REFSEL 25 Clock Gen Fractional 1 1 100 100 0 1 n/a Disabled 5000 8 64 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Table 17. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Outputs [0-4] Configuration GPIO[5:0] (decimal) OUT0-1 DIVIDER OUT0-1 FREQ (MHz) OUT0 TYPE OUT1 TYPE OUT2-3 DIVIDER OUT2-3 FREQ (MHz) OUT2 TYPE OUT3 TYPE OUT4 DIV OUT4 FREQ (MHz) OUT4 MUX SELECT OUT4 TYPE 0 5 200 LVDS LVDS 10 100 LVDS LVDS 1 n/a n/a Disable 1 5 200 LVDS LVDS 10 100 LVDS LVDS 1 n/a n/a Disable 2 10 100 LVDS LVDS 10 100 LVDS LVDS 8 125 PLL LVDS 3 4 312.5 LVDS LVDS 8 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 10 125 PLL LVDS 4 20 125 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 PLL LVPECL 5 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 PLL LVPECL 6 4 307.2 LVPECL LVPECL 5 245.76 LVDS LVDS 8 153.6 PLL LVDS 7 4 307.2 LVPECL LVPECL 5 245.76 LVPECL LVPECL 8 153.6 PLL LVDS 8 4 307.2 LVPECL LVPECL 5 245.76 LVDS LVDS 8 153.6 PLL LVDS 9 6 106.25 LVPECL LVPECL 6 106.25 LVPECL LVPECL 3 212.5 PLL LVPECL 10 6 106.25 LVDS LVDS 6 106.25 LVDS LVDS 3 212.5 PLL LVDS 11 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 20 125 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 PLL HCSL 12 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 20 125 LVDS LVDS 25 100 PLL HCSL 13 16 106.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 106.25 LVPECL LVPECL 17 100 PLL HCSL 14 16 106.25 LVDS LVDS 16 106.25 LVDS LVDS 17 100 PLL HCSL 15 4 425 LVPECL LVPECL 8 212.5 LVPECL LVPECL 17 100 PLL HCSL 16 4 425 LVDS LVDS 8 212.5 LVDS LVDS 17 100 PLL HCSL 17 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 18 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 19 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 20 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 21 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 22 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 23 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 PLL LVDS 24 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 25 100 PLL LVDS 25 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 PLL LVDS 26 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 25 100 PLL LVDS 27 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 LVPECL LVPECL 50 50 PLL LVPECL 28 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 29 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 30 8 312.5 LVDS LVDS 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 PLL LVDS 31 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 PLL LVPECL 32 4 625 LVDS LVDS 4 625 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 PLL LVDS Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 65 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 17. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Outputs [0-4] Configuration (continued) GPIO[5:0] (decimal) OUT0-1 DIVIDER OUT0-1 FREQ (MHz) OUT0 TYPE OUT1 TYPE OUT2-3 DIVIDER OUT2-3 FREQ (MHz) OUT2 TYPE OUT3 TYPE OUT4 DIV OUT4 FREQ (MHz) OUT4 MUX SELECT OUT4 TYPE 33 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 34 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 35 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 36 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 37 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 5 125 LVDS LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 38 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 5 125 LVDS LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 39 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 5 125 HCSL HCSL 5 125 PLL LVDS 40 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 5 125 LVDS LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 41 2 311.04 LVPECL LVPECL 4 155.52 LVDS LVDS 4 155.52 PLL LVPECL 42 2 311.04 LVDS LVDS 4 155.52 LVPECL LVPECL 4 155.52 PLL LVDS 43 1 622.08 LVPECL LVPECL 1 622.08 LVPECL LVPECL 4 155.52 PLL LVDS 44 1 622.08 LVDS LVDS 1 622.08 LVPECL LVPECL 4 155.52 PLL LVDS 45 10 100 LVPECL LVPECL 10 100 LVPECL LVPECL 4 250 PLL LVPECL 46 10 100 LVDS LVDS 10 100 LVPECL LVPECL 4 250 PLL LVDS 47 25 25 LVPECL LVPECL 2 312.5 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 48 25 25 LVDS LVDS 2 312.5 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 49 25 25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 50 25 25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 LVDS LVDS 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 51 25 106.25 LVPECL LVPECL 25 106.25 LVPECL LVPECL 17 156.25 PLL LVPECL 52 25 106.25 LVDS LVDS 25 106.25 LVDS LVDS 17 156.25 PLL LVDS 53 4 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL 4 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 54 4 161.1328125 LVDS LVDS 4 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 55 4 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL 4 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 56 4 161.1328125 LVDS LVDS 4 161.1328125 LVPECL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 57 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 16 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 25 100 PLL HCSL 58 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 16 156.25 LVDS LVDS 25 100 PLL HCSL 59 2 312.5 LVPECL LVPECL 2 312.5 LVPECL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 60 2 312.5 LVPECL LVPECL 2 312.5 LVPECL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 61 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 62 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 LVPECL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 63 5 125 LVPECL LVPECL 5 125 LVPECL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 66 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Table 18. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Outputs [5-7] Configuration GPIO[5:0] (decimal) OUT5 DIV OUT5 FREQ (MHz) OUT5 MUX SELECT OUT5 TYPE OUT6 DIV OUT6 FREQ (MHz) OUT6 MUX SELECT OUT6 TYPE OUT7 DIV OUT7 FREQ (MHz) OUT7 MUX SELECT OUT7 TYPE 0 1 n/a n/a Disable 1 n/a n/a Disable 1 n/a n/a Disable 1 1 n/a n/a Disable 1 n/a n/a Disable 1 n/a n/a Disable 2 8 125 PLL LVDS 8 125 PLL LVDS 8 125 PLL LVDS 3 10 125 PLL LVDS 25 50 PLL LVDS 25 50 PLL LVDS 4 20 125 PLL LVPECL 16 156.25 PLL LVPECL 16 156.25 PLL LVPECL 5 20 125 PLL LVPECL 20 125 PLL LVPECL 20 125 PLL LVPECL 6 8 153.6 PLL LVDS 10 122.88 PLL LVDS 10 122.88 PLL LVDS 7 8 153.6 PLL LVDS 10 122.88 PLL LVDS 10 122.88 PLL LVDS 8 8 153.6 PLL LVDS 10 122.88 PLL LVDS 10 122.88 PLL LVDS LVPECL 9 3 212.5 PLL LVPECL 3 212.5 PLL LVPECL 3 212.5 PLL 10 3 212.5 PLL LVDS 3 212.5 PLL LVDS 3 212.5 PLL LVDS 11 25 100 PLL HCSL 100 25 PLL LVDS 100 25 PLL LVCMOS 12 25 100 PLL HCSL 100 25 PLL LVDS 100 25 PLL LVCMOS 13 17 100 PLL HCSL 17 100 PLL HCSL 17 100 PLL HCSL 14 17 100 PLL HCSL 17 100 PLL HCSL 17 100 PLL HCSL 15 34 50 PLL LVDS 3 566.67 PLL LVPECL 16 106.25 PLL LVDS 16 34 50 PLL LVDS 3 566.67 PLL LVPECL 16 106.25 PLL LVDS 17 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 18 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 19 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 20 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 21 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 22 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 23 25 100 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 24 25 100 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 25 25 100 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 26 25 100 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 27 20 125 PLL LVPECL 25 100 PLL LVCMOS 100 25 PLL LVCMOS 28 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 25 25 PLL LVCMOS 29 25 25 PLL LVCMOS 25 25 PLL LVCMOS 25 25 PLL LVCMOS 30 8 312.5 PLL LVDS 25 100 PLL LVDS 20 125 PLL LVDS 31 25 100 PLL HCSL 25 100 PLL HCSL 100 25 PLL LVPECL Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 67 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 18. Default ROM Contents (HW_SW_CTRL = 1) - Outputs [5-7] Configuration (continued) GPIO[5:0] (decimal) OUT5 DIV OUT5 FREQ (MHz) OUT5 MUX SELECT OUT5 TYPE OUT6 DIV OUT6 FREQ (MHz) OUT6 MUX SELECT OUT6 TYPE OUT7 DIV OUT7 FREQ (MHz) OUT7 MUX SELECT OUT7 TYPE 32 25 100 PLL LVDS 25 100 PLL LVDS 25 100 PLL LVDS 33 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 34 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 35 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 36 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 37 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 38 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 39 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 40 4 156.25 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVCMOS 41 4 155.52 PLL LVPECL 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 42 4 155.52 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 43 4 155.52 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 44 4 155.52 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 8 77.76 PLL LVDS 45 4 250 PLL LVPECL 40 25 PLL LVCMOS 15 66.67 PLL LVCMOS 46 4 250 PLL LVDS 40 25 PLL LVCMOS 15 66.67 PLL LVCMOS 47 10 62.5 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 48 10 62.5 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 2 312.5 PLL LVDS 49 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 68 50 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 5 125 PLL LVDS 51 17 156.25 PLL LVPECL 17 156.25 PLL LVPECL 17 156.25 PLL LVPECL 52 17 156.25 PLL LVDS 17 156.25 PLL LVDS 17 156.25 PLL LVDS 53 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 54 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 55 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 2 322.265625 PLL LVPECL 56 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 2 322.265625 PLL LVDS 57 25 100 PLL HCSL 25 100 PLL HCSL 25 100 PLL HCSL 58 25 100 PLL HCSL 25 100 PLL HCSL 25 100 PLL HCSL 59 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 60 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 2 312.5 PLL LVPECL 61 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 62 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 4 156.25 PLL LVPECL 63 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL 5 125 PLL LVPECL Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7 Register Maps The register map is shown in the table below. The registers occupy a single unified address space and all registers are accessible at any time. A total of 103 registers are present in the LMK03318. Name Address Reset Bit7 VNDRID_BY1 0 0x10 VNDRID[15:8] Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 VNDRID_BY0 1 0x0B VNDRID[7:0] PRODID 2 0x31 PRODID[7:0] REVID 3 0x00 REVID[7:0] PARTID_BY3 4 0x00 PRTID[31:24] PARTID_BY2 5 0x00 PRTID[23:16] PARTID_BY1 6 0x00 PRTID[15:8] PARTID_BY0 7 0x00 PRTID[7:0] PINMODE_SW 8 0x00 HW_SW_CTR L_MODE PINMODE_HW 9 0x00 GPIO_HW_MODE[5:0] SLAVEADR 10 0x50 SLAVEADR_GPIO1_SW[7:1] EEREV 11 0x00 EEREV[7:0] DEV_CTL 12 0xD9 RESETN_SW SYNCN_SW RSRVD SYNC_AUTO INT_LIVE 13 0x00 LOL LOS CAL INT_MASK 14 0x00 LOL_MASK LOS_MASK CAL_MASK INT_FLAG_POL 15 0x00 LOL_POL LOS_POL INT_FLAG 16 0x00 LOL_INTR INTCTL 17 0x00 RSRVD OSCCTL2 18 0x00 RISE_VALID_ SEC STATCTL 19 0x00 RSRVD MUTELVL1 20 0x55 MUTELVL2 21 0x55 OUT_MUTE 22 STATUS_MUTE 23 DYN_DLY 24 GPIO32_SW_MODE[2:0] Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD PLLSTRTMODE AUTOSTRT RSRVD SECTOPRI RSRVD RSRVD SECTOPRI_ MASK RSRVD CAL_POL RSRVD SECTOPRI_ POL RSRVD LOS_INTR CAL_INTR RSRVD SECTOPRI_ INTR RSRVD INT_AND_OR INT_EN FALL_VALID_ SEC RISE_VALID_ PRI FALL_VALID_ PRI STAT1_SHOOT_ STAT0_SHOOT_ RSRVD THRU_LIMIT THRU_LIMIT STAT1_OPEND STAT0_OPEND CH3_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH2_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH1_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH0_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH7_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH6_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH5_MUTE_LVL[1:0] CH4_MUTE_LVL[1:0] 0xFF CH_7_MUTE CH_5_MUTE CH_3_MUTE CH_1_MUTE CH_0_MUTE 0x02 RSRVD STATUS1_ MUTE STATUS0_ MUTE 0x00 RSRVD DIV_23_DYN_ DLY DIV_01_DYN_ DLY CH_6_MUTE DIV_7_DYN_ DLY CH_4_MUTE DIV_6_DYN_ DLY SYNC_MUTE AONAFTER LOCK RSRVD DIV_5_DYN_ DLY CH_2_MUTE DIV_4_DYN_ DLY Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 69 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Register Maps (continued) Name Address Reset Bit7 REFDETCTL 25 0x55 DETECT_MODE_SEC[1:0] STAT0_INT 27 0x58 STAT0_SEL[3:0] STAT0_POL RSRVD STAT1 28 0x28 STAT1_SEL[3:0] STAT1_POL RSRVD OSCCTL1 29 0x06 DETECT_BYP RSRVD TERM2GND_ SEC TERM2GND_ PRI DIFFTERM_SEC DIFFTERM_PRI AC_MODE_SEC AC_MODE_PRI PWDN 30 0x00 RSRVD CMOSCHPWDN CH7PWDN CH6PWDN CH5PWDN CH23PWDN OUTCTL_0 31 0xB0 RSRVD OUT_0_SEL[1:0] OUT_0_MODE1[1:0] OUT_0_MODE2[1:0] RSRVD OUTCTL_1 32 0x30 RSRVD OUT_1_SEL[1:0] OUT_1_MODE1[1:0] OUT_1_MODE2[1:0] RSRVD OUTDIV_0_1 33 0x01 OUT_0_1_DIV[7:0] OUTCTL_2 34 0xB0 RSRVD OUT_2_SEL[1:0] OUT_2_MODE1[1:0] OUT_2_MODE2[1:0] RSRVD OUTCTL_3 35 0x30 RSRVD OUT_3_SEL[1:0] OUT_3_MODE1[1:0] OUT_3_MODE2[1:0] RSRVD OUTDIV_2_3 36 0x03 OUT_2_3_DIV[7:0] OUTCTL_4 37 0x18 CH_4_MUX[1:0] OUTDIV_4 38 0x02 OUT_4_DIV[7:0] OUTCTL_5 39 0x18 CH_5_MUX[1:0] OUTDIV_5 40 0x02 OUT_5_DIV[7:0] OUTCTL_6 41 0x18 CH_6_MUX[1:0] OUTDIV_6 42 0x05 OUT_6_DIV[7:0] OUTCTL_7 43 0x18 CH_7_MUX[1:0] OUTDIV_7 44 0x05 OUT_7_DIV[7:0] CMOSDIVCTRL 45 0x0A RSRVD CMOSDIV0 46 0x00 CMOSDIV0[7:0] STATUS_SLEW 49 0x00 RSRVD IPCLKSEL 50 0x95 SECBUFSEL[1:0] IPCLKCTL 51 0x03 CLKMUX_ BYPASS PLL_RDIV 52 0x00 RSRVD PLL_MDIV 53 0x00 RSRVD PLLMDIV[4:0] PLL_CTRL0 56 0x1E RSRVD PLL_P[2:0] PLL_CTRL1 57 0x18 RSRVD PRI_D PLL_NDIV_BY1 58 0x00 RSRVD PLL_NDIV_BY0 59 0x66 PLL_NDIV[7:0] PLL_ FRACNUM_BY2 60 0x00 RSRVD 70 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 DETECT_MODE_PRI[1:0] Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 LVL_SEL_SEC[1:0] Bit0 LVL_SEL_PRI[1:0] CH4PWDN CH01PWDN OUT_4_SEL[1:0] OUT_4_MODE1[1:0] OUT_4_MODE2[1:0] OUT_5_SEL[1:0] OUT_5_MODE1[1:0] OUT_5_MODE2[1:0] OUT_6_SEL[1:0] OUT_6_MODE1[1:0] OUT_6_MODE2[1:0] OUT_7_SEL[1:0] OUT_7_MODE1[1:0] OUT_7_MODE2[1:0] PLLCMOSPREDIV[1:0] STATUS1MUX[1:0] STATUS0MUX[1:0] STATUS1SLEW[1:0] STATUS0SLEW[1:0] RSRVD INSEL_PLL[1:0] PRIBUFSEL[1:0] RSRVD SECONSWITCH SECBUFGAIN PRIBUFGAIN PLL_SYNC_EN PLL_PDN PLLRDIV[2:0] PLL_CP[3:0] PLL_NDIV[11:8] PLL_NUM[21:16] Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Register Maps (continued) Name Address Reset Bit7 PLL_ FRACNUM_BY1 61 0x00 PLL_NUM[15:8] PLL_ FRACNUM_BY0 62 0x00 PLL_NUM[7:0] PLL_ FRACDEN_BY2 63 0x00 RSRVD PLL_ FRACDEN_BY1 64 0x00 PLL_DEN[15:8] PLL_ FRACDEN_BY0 65 0x00 PLL_DEN[7:0] PLL_ MASHCTRL 66 0x0C RSRVD PLL_LF_R2 67 0x24 RSRVD PLL_LF_C1 68 0x00 RSRVD PLL_LF_R3 69 0x00 RSRVD PLL_LF_C3 70 0x00 RSRVD SEC_CTRL Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 PLL_DEN[21:16] PLL_DTHRMODE[1:0] PLL_ORDER[1:0] PLL_LF_R2[5:0] PLL_LF_C1[2:0] PLL_LF_R3[6:0] PLL_LF_C3[2:0] 72 0x18 RSRVD XO_MARGINING 86 0x00 RSRVD SEC_D XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_1 _BY1 88 0x00 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_1 _BY0 89 0xDE XOOFFSET_STEP1[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_2 _BY1 90 0x01 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_2 _BY0 91 0x18 XOOFFSET_STEP2[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_3 _BY1 92 0x01 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_3 _BY0 93 0x4B XOOFFSET_STEP3[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_4 _BY1 94 0x01 RSRVD MARGIN_DIG_STEP[2:0] RSRVD MARGIN_OPTION[1:0] RSRVD RSRVD XOOFFSET_STEP1[9:8] XOOFFSET_STEP2[9:8] XOOFFSET_STEP3[9:8] XOOFFSET_STEP4[9:8] Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 71 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Register Maps (continued) Name Address Reset Bit7 XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_4 _BY0 95 0x86 XOOFFSET_STEP4[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_5 _BY1 96 0x01 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_5 _BY0 97 0xBE XOOFFSET_STEP5[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_6 _BY1 98 0x01 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_6 _BY0 99 0xFE XOOFFSET_STEP6[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_7 _BY1 100 0x02 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_7 _BY0 101 0x47 XOOFFSET_STEP7[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_8 _BY1 102 0x02 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ GPIO5_STEP_8 _BY0 103 0x9E XOOFFSET_STEP8[7:0] XO_OFFSET_ SW_BY1 104 0x00 RSRVD XO_OFFSET_ SW_BY0 105 0x00 XOOFFSET_SW[7:0] PLL_CTRL2 117 0x00 PLL_STRETC H PLL_CTRL3 118 0x03 RSRVD PLL_ CALCTRL0 119 0x01 RSRVD PLL_ CALCTRL1 120 0x00 RSRVD NVMSCRC 135 0x00 NVMSCRC[7:0] NVMCNT 136 0x00 NVMCNT[7:0] NVMCTL 137 0x10 RSRVD 72 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 XOOFFSET_STEP5[9:8] XOOFFSET_STEP6[9:8] XOOFFSET_STEP7[9:8] XOOFFSET_STEP8[9:8] XOOFFSET_SW[9:8] RSRVD PLL_DISABLE_4TH[2:0] PLL_CLSDWAIT[1:0] PLL_VCOWAIT[1:0] PLL_LOOPBW REGCOMMIT NVMCRCERR NVMAUTOCRC Submit Documentation Feedback NVMCOMMIT NVMBUSY RSRVD NVMPROG Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Register Maps (continued) Name Address Reset Bit7 NVMLCRC 138 0x00 NVMLCRC[7:0] Bit6 MEMADR_BY1 139 0x00 RSRVD MEMADR_BY0 140 0x00 MEMADR[7:0] NVMDAT 141 0x00 NVMDAT[7:0] RAMDAT 142 0x00 RAMDAT[7:0] ROMDAT 143 0x00 ROMDAT[7:0] NVMUNLK 144 0x00 NVMUNLK[7:0] REGCOMMIT_ PAGE 145 0x00 RSRVD XOCAPCTRL_ BY1 199 0x00 RSRVD XOCAPCTRL_ BY0 200 0x00 XO_CAP_CTRL[7:0] Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 MEMADR[11:8] REGCOMMIT_PG[3:0] XO_CAP_CTRL[9:8] Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 73 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.1 VNDRID_BY1 Register; R0 The VNDRID_BY1 and VNDRID_BY0 registers are used to store the unique 16-bit Vendor Identification number assigned to I2C vendors. Bit # Field [7:0] VNDRID[15:8] Type Reset R 0x10 NVM Description N Vendor Identification Number Byte 1. The Vendor Identification Number is a unique 16-bit identification number assigned to I2C vendors. 10.7.2 VNDRID_BY0 Register; R1 The VNDRID_BY0 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:0] VNDRID[7:0] Type Reset R 0xB NVM Description N Vendor Identification Number Byte 0. 10.7.3 PRODID Register; R2 The PRODID register is used to identify the LMK03318 device. Bit # Field [7:0] PRODID[7:0] Type Reset R 0x31 NVM Description N Product Identification Number. The Product Identification Number is a unique 8-bit identification number used to identify the LMK03318. 10.7.4 REVID Register; R3 The REVID register is used to identify the LMK03318 mask revision. Bit # Field [7:0] REVID[7:0] Type Reset R 0x0 NVM Description N Device Revision Number. The Device Revision Number is used to identify the LMK03318 die revision 10.7.5 PARTID_BY3 Register; R4 Each LMK03318 device can be identified by a unique 32-bit number stored in the PARTID_BY3, PARTID_BY2, PARTID_BY1 and PARTID_BY0 registers. These registers are always initialized from on-chip EEPROM. Bit # Field [7:0] PRTID[31:24] Type Reset R 0x0 NVM Description Y Part Identification Number Byte 3. The Part Identification Number is a unique 32-bit number which is used to serialize individual LMK03318 devices. The Part Identification Number is factory programmed and cannot be modified by the user. 10.7.6 PARTID_BY2 Register; R5 The PARTID_BY2 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:0] PRTID[23:16] Type Reset R 0x0 NVM Description Y Part Identification Number Byte 2. 10.7.7 PARTID_BY1 Register; R6 The PARTID_BY1 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:0] PRTID[15:8] Type Reset R 0x0 NVM Description Y Part Identification Number Byte 1. 10.7.8 PARTID_BY0 Register; R7 The PARTID_BY0 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:0] 74 PRTID[7:0] Typ Reset e R 0x0 NVM Description Y Part Identification Number Byte 0. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.9 PINMODE_SW Register; R8 The PINMODE_SW register records the device configuration setting. The configuration setting is registered when the reset is deasserted. Bit # Field Type Reset [7] HW_SW_CTRL_M R 0 ODE NVM N [6:4] GPIO32_SW_MO DE[2:0] R 0x0 N [3:0] RSRVD - - N Description HW_SW_CTRL Pin Configuration. The HW_SW_CTRL_MODE field reflects the values sampled on the HW_SW_CTRL pin on the most recent device reset. HW_SW_CTRL_MODE HW_SW_CTRL 0 Soft Pin Mode 1 Hard Pin Mode GPIO32_SW Pin Configuration Mode. The GPIO_SW_MODE field reflects the values sampled on the GPIO[3:2] pins when HW_SW_CTRL is 0 on the most recent device reset. When HW_SW_CTRL is 1 this field reads back 0x0. GPIO_SW_MODE GPIO[3] GPIO[2] 0 0 0 1 0 Z 2 0 1 3 1 0 4 1 Z 5 1 1 Reserved. 10.7.10 PINMODE_HW Register; R9 The PINMODE_HW register records the device configuration setting. The configuration setting is registered when the reset is deasserted. Bit # Field [7:2] GPIO_HW_MOD E[5:0] Type Reset R 0x0 [1:0] - RSRVD - NVM Description N GPIO_HW[5:0] Pin Configuration Mode. The GPIO_HW_MODE field reflects the values sampled on pins GPIO[5:0] when HW_SW_CTRL is 1 on the most recent device reset. When HW_SW_CTRL is 0 this field reads back 0x0. GPIO_HW_MODE GPIO[5:0] 0 0b000000 1 0b000001 2 0b000010 .. .. .. .. 61 0b111101 62 0b111110 63 0b111111 N Reserved. 10.7.11 SLAVEADR Register; R10 The SLAVEADR register reflects the 7-bit I2C Slave Address value initialized from on-chip EEPROM. Bit # Field [7:1] SLAVEADR_GPI O1_SW[7:1] Type Reset R 0x50 NVM Y [0] - N RSRVD - Description I2C Slave Address. This field holds the 7-bit Slave Address used to identify this device during I2C transactions. When HW_SW_CTRL is 0 the two least significant bits of the address can be configured using GPIO[1] as shown. When HW_SW_CTRL is 1 then the two least significant bits are 00. SLAVEADR_GPIO1_SW[2:1] GPIO[1] 00 0 01 VIM 11 1 Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 75 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.12 EEREV Register; R11 The EEREV register provides EEPROM/ROM image revision record and is initialized from EEPROM or ROM. Bit # Field [7:0] EEREV[7:0] Type Reset R 0x0 NVM Y Description EEPROM Image Revision ID. EEPROM Image Revision is automatically retrieved from EEPROM and stored in the EEREV register after a reset or after a NVM commit operation. 10.7.13 DEV_CTL Register; R12 The DEV_CTL register holds the control functions described in the following table. Bit # [7] Field Type Reset NVM Description RESETN_SW RW 1 N [6] SYNCN_SW RW 1 N [5] [4] RSRVD SYNC_AUTO RW 1 N Y [3] SYNC_MUTE RW 1 Y [2] AONAFTERLOCK RW 0 Y [1] [0] RSRVD AUTOSTRT RW RW 0 1 Y Y Software Reset ALL functions (active low). Writing a 0 will cause the device to return to its power-up state apart from the I2C registers and the configuration controller. The configuration controller is excluded to prevent a re-transfer of EEPROM data to on-chip registers. Software SYNC Assertion (active low). Writing a 0 to this bit is equivalent to asserting the GPIO0 pin. Reserved. Automatic Synchronization at startup. When SYNC_AUTO is 1 at device startup a synchronization sequence is initiated automatically after PLL lock has been achieved. Synchronization Mute Control. The SYNC_MUTE field determines whether or not the output drivers are muted during a Synchronization event. SYNC_MUTE SYNC Mute Behaviour 0 Do not mute any outputs during SYNC 1 Mute all outputs during SYNC Always On Clock behaviour after Lock. If AONAFTERLOCK is 0 then the system clock is switched from the Always On Clock to the VCO Clock after lock and the Always On Clock oscillator is disabled. If AONAFTERLOCK is 1 then the Always on Clock will remain as the digital system clock regardless of the PLL Lock state. It is recommended that AONAFTERLOCK be set to 1. Reserved. Autostart. If AUTOSTRT is set to 1 the device will automatically attempt to achieve lock and enable outputs after a device reset. A device reset can be triggered by the poweron-reset, RESETn pin or by writing to the RESETN_SW bit. If AUTOSTRT is 0 then the device will halt after the configuration phase, a subsequent write to set the AUTOSTRT bit to 1 will trigger the PLL Lock sequence. 10.7.14 INT_LIVE Register; R13 The INT_LIVE register reflects the current status of the interrupt sources, regardless of the state of the INT_EN bit. Bit # [7] [6] [5] [4:2] [1] [0] 76 Field LOL LOS CAL RSRVD SECTOPRI RSRVD Type R R R R - Reset 0 0 0 0 - NVM N N N N N N Description Loss of Lock PLL. Loss of Signal PLL. Calibration Active PLL. Reserved. Switch from Secondary Reference to Primary Reference in Automatic Mode PLL. Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.15 INT_MASK Register; R14 The INT_MASK register allows masking of the interrupt sources. Bit # Field [7] LOL_MASK Type Reset RW 0 [6] LOS_MASK RW 0 [5] CAL_MASK RW 0 [4:2] [1] RSRVD RW SECTOPRI_MAS RW K 0 0 [0] RSRVD 0 RW NVM Description Y Mask Loss of Lock PLL. When LOL_MASK is 1 then the LOL interrupt source is masked and will not cause the interrupt signal to be activated. Y Mask Loss of Signal PLL. When LOS_MASK is 1 then the LOS interrupt source is masked and will not cause the interrupt signal to be activated. Y Mask Calibration Active PLL. When CAL_MASK is 1 then the CAL interrupt source is masked and will not cause the interrupt signal to be activated. Y Reserved. Y Mask Switch from Secondary Reference to Primary Reference PLL. When SECTOPRI_MASK is 1 then the SECTOPRI interrupt source is masked and will not cause the interrupt signal to be activated. Y Reserved. 10.7.16 INT_FLAG_POL Register; R15 The INT_FLAG_POL register controls the signal polarity that sets the Interrupt Flags. Bit # Field [7] LOL_POL Type Reset RW 0 [6] LOS_POL RW 0 [5] CAL_POL RW 0 [4:2] [1] RSRVD SECTOPRI_POL RW RW 0 0 [0] RSRVD RW 0 NVM Description Y LOL Flag Polarity. When LOL_POL is 1 then a rising edge on LOL will set the LOL_INTR bit of the INTERRUPT_FLAG register. When LOL_POL is 0 then a falling edge on LOL will set the LOL_INTR bit. Y LOS Flag Polarity. When LOS_POL is 1 then a rising edge on LOS will set the LOS_INTR bit of the INTERRUPT_FLAG register. When LOS_POL is 0 then a falling edge on LOS will set the LOS_INTR bit. Y CAL Flag Polarity. When CAL_POL is 1 then a rising edge on CAL will set the CAL_INTR bit of the INTERRUPT_FLAG register. When CAL_POL is 0 then a falling edge on CAL1 will set the CAL_INTR bit. Y Reserved. Y SECTOPRI Flag Polarity. When SECTOPRI_POL is 1 then a rising edge on SECTOPRI will set the SECTOPRI_INTR bit of the INTERRUPT_FLAG register. When SECTOPRI_POL is 0 then a falling edge on SECTOPRI will set the SECTOPRI_INTR bit. Y Reserved. 10.7.17 INT_FLAG Register; R16 The INT_FLAG register records rising or falling edges on the interrupt sources. The polarity is controlled by the INT_FLAG_POL register. This register is only updated if the INT_EN register bit is set to 1. Bit # Field [7] LOL_INTR Type Reset R 0 NVM N [6] LOS_INTR R 0 N [5] CAL_INTR R 0 N [4:2] [1] RSRVD SECTOPRI_INT R R R 0 0 N N [0] RSRVD R 0 N Description LOL Interrupt. The LOL_INTR bit is set when an edge of the correct polarity is detected on the LOL interrupt source. The LOL_INTR bit is cleared by writing a 0. LOS Interrupt. The LOS_INTR bit is set when an edge of the correct polarity is detected on the LOS interrupt source. The LOS_INTR bit is cleared by writing a 0. CAL Interrupt. The CAL_INTR bit is set when an edge of the correct polarity is detected on the CAL interrupt source. The CAL_INTR bit is cleared by writing a 0. Reserved. SECTOPRI Interrupt. The SECTOPRI_INTR bit is set when an edge of the correct polarity is detected on the SECTOPRI interrupt source. The SECTOPRI_INTR bit is cleared by writing a 0. Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 77 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.18 INTCTL Register; R17 The INTCTL register allows configuration of the Interrupt operation. Bit # Field [7:2] RSRVD [1] INT_AND_OR Type Reset RW 0 NVM N Y [0] RW Y INT_EN 0 Description Reserved. Interrupt AND/OR Combination. If INT_AND_OR is 1 then the interrupts are combined in an AND structure. In which case ALL un mAsked interrupt flags must be active in order to generate the interrupt. If INT_AND_OR is 0 then the interrupts are combined in an OR structure. In which case ANY un mAsked interrupt flags can generate the interrupt INT_AND_OR Interrupt Function 0 OR 1 AND Interrupt Enable. If INT_EN is 1 then the interrupt circuit is enabled, if INT_EN is 0 the interrupt circuit is disabled. When INT_EN is 0, interrupts cannot be signalled on the STATUS pins and the INT_FLAG registers will not be updated, however the INT_LIVE register will still reflect the current state of the internal interrupt signals. 10.7.19 OSCCTL2 Register; R18 The OSCCTL2 register provides access to input reference status signals Bit # [7] [6] [5] [4] [3:0 ] Field RISE_VALID_SEC FALL_VALID_SEC RISE_VALID_PRI FALL_VALID_PRI RSRVD Type Rese t R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 - NVM Description N N N N N Secondary Input Rising Valid Indicator from Slew Rate Detector. Secondary Input Falling Valid Indicator from Slew Rate Detector. Primary Input Rising Valid Indicator from Slew Rate Detector. Primary Input Falling Valid Indicator from Slew Rate Detector. Reserved. 10.7.20 STATCTL Register; R19 The STATCTL register provides to STATUS0/1 output driver control signals. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:6] RSRVD [5] STAT1_SHOOT_ RW 0 THRU_LIMIT NVM N Y [4] STAT0_SHOOT_ RW THRU_LIMIT 0 Y [3:2] [1] RSRVD STAT1_OPEND RW RW 0x0 0 Y Y [0] STAT0_OPEND RW 0 Y 78 Description Reserved. STATUS1 Output Shoot Through Current Limit. When STAT1_SHOOT_THRU_LIMIT is 1 then the transient current spikes are minimized, the performance of the STATUS1 output is degraded in this mode. STATUS0 Output Shoot Through Current Limit. When STAT0_SHOOT_THRU_LIMIT is 1 then the transient current spikes are minimized, the performance of the STATUS0 output is degraded in this mode. Reserved. STATUS1 Open Drain Enable. When STAT1_OPEND is 1 the STATUS1 output is configured as an open drain output driver. STATUS0 Open Drain Enable. When STAT0_OPEND is 1 the STATUS0 output is configured as an open drain output driver. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.21 MUTELVL1 Register; R20 The MUTELVL1 register determines the Output Driver during mute for output drivers 0 to 3. Bit # Field Type Reset NVM [7:6] CH3_MUTE_LVL RW 0x1 Y [1:0] [5:4] CH2_MUTE_LVL RW [1:0] 0x1 Y [3:2] CH1_MUTE_LVL RW [1:0] 0x1 Y Description Channel 3 Output Driver Mute Level. CH3_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH3 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH3_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH3 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_3_MUTE register bit. CH3_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH3 Mute Bypass CH3 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail Channel 2 Output Driver Mute Level. CH2_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH2 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH2_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH2 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_2_MUTE register bit. CH2_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH2 Mute Bypass CH2 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail Channel 1 Output Driver Mute Level. CH1_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH1 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH1_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH1 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_1_MUTE register bit. CH1_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH1 Mute Bypass CH1 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 79 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Bit # Field Type Reset NVM [1:0] CH0_MUTE_LVL RW 0x1 Y [1:0] www.ti.com Description Channel 0 Output Driver Mute Level. CH0_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH0 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH0_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH0 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_0_MUTE register bit. CH0_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH0 Mute Bypass CH0 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail 10.7.22 MUTELVL2 Register; R21 The MUTELVL2 register determines the Output Driver during mute for output drivers 4 to 7. Bit # Field [7:6] CH7_MUTE_LV L[1:0] Type Reset RW 0x1 [5:4] RW 80 CH6_MUTE_LV L[1:0] 0x1 NVM Description Y Channel 7 Output Driver Mute Level. CH7_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH7 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH7_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH7 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_7_MUTE register bit. CH7_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH7 Mute Bypass CH7 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail Y Channel 6 Output Driver Mute Level. CH6_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH6 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH6_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH6 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_6_MUTE register bit. CH6_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH6 Mute Bypass CH6 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Input Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Bit # Field [3:2] CH5_MUTE_LV L[1:0] Type Reset RW 0x1 [1:0] RW CH4_MUTE_LV L[1:0] 0x1 NVM Description Y Channel 5 Output Driver Mute Level. CH5_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH5 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH5_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH5 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_5_MUTE register bit. CH5_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH5 Mute Bypass CH5 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail Y Channel 4 Output Driver Mute Level. CH4_MUTE_LVL determines the configuration of the CH4 Output Driver during mute as shown in the following table and is recommended to be set to 11. CH4_MUTE_LVL does not determine whether the CH4 driver is muted or not, instead this is determined by the CH_4_MUTE register bit. CH4_MUTE_LVL DIFF MODE CMOS MODE 0 CH4 Mute Bypass CH4 Mute Bypass 1 Powerdown, output goes to Out_P Normal Operation, Vcm Out_N Force Output Low 2 Force output High Out_P Force Output Low, Out_N Normal Operation 3 Force the positive output Out_P Force Output Low, node to the internal Out_N Force Output Low regulator output voltage rail (when AC coupled to load) and the negative output node to the GND rail 10.7.23 OUT_MUTE Register; R22 Output Channel Mute Control Bit # Field [7] CH_7_MUTE Type Reset RW 1 [6] CH_6_MUTE RW 1 [5] CH_5_MUTE RW 1 [4] CH_4_MUTE RW 1 [3] CH_3_MUTE RW 1 [2] CH_2_MUTE RW 1 [1] CH_1_MUTE RW 1 [0] CH_0_MUTE RW 1 NVM Description Y Channel 7 Mute Control. When CH_7_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 7 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_7_MUTE_7 is 0 Channel 7 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 6 Mute Control. When CH_6_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 6 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_6_MUTE_6 is 0 Channel 6 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 5 Mute Control. When CH_5_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 5 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_5_MUTE_5 is 0 Channel 5 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 4 Mute Control. When CH_4_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 4 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_4_MUTE_4 is 0 Channel 4 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 3 Mute Control. When CH_3_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 3 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_3_MUTE is 0 Channel 3 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 2 Mute Control. When CH_2_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 2 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_2_MUTE is 0 Channel 2 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 1 Mute Control. When CH_1_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 1 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_1_MUTE is 0 Channel 1 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Y Channel 0 Mute Control. When CH_0_MUTE is set to 1 Output Channel 0 is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When CH_0_MUTE is 0 Channel 0 will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 81 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.24 STATUS_MUTE Register; R23 Status CMOS Output Mute Control Bit # Field Type Reset [7:2] RSRVD [1] STATUS1_MUTE RW 1 [0] STATUS0_MUTE RW NVM Description N Reserved. Y STATUS 1 Mute Control. When the STATUS1 output is configuted to provide a CMOS Clock and the STATUS1_MUTE bit is set to 1 then the STATUS1 Output is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When STATUS1_MUTE is 0 the STATUS1 Output will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. If the STATUS1 output is not configured to provide a Clock then it will continue to operate regardless of the STATUS1_MUTE bit value. Y STATUS 0 Mute Control. When the STATUS0 output is configuted to provide a CMOS Clock and the STATUS0_MUTE bit is set to 1 then the STATUS0 Output is automatically disabled when the selected clock source is invalid. When STATUS0_MUTE is 0 the STATUS0 Output will continue to operate regardless of the state of the selected clock source. If the STATUS0 output is not configured to provide a Clock then it will continue to operate regardless of the STATUS0_MUTE bit value. 0 10.7.25 DYN_DLY Register; R24 Output Divider Dynamic Delay Control Bit # Field [7:6] RSRVD [5] DIV_7_DYN_DLY Type Reset RW 0 [4] DIV_6_DYN_DLY RW 0 [3] DIV_5_DYN_DLY RW 0 [2] DIV_4_DYN_DLY RW 0 [1] DIV_23_DYN_DLY RW 0 [0] DIV_01_DYN_DLY RW 0 NVM Description N Reserved. Y Channel 7 Divider Dynamic Delay Control. Enables coarse frequency margining for divide value > 8 Y Channel 6 Divider Dynamic Delay Control. Enables coarse frequency margining for divide value > 8 Y Channel 5 Divider Dynamic Delay Control. Enables coarse frequency margining for divide value > 8 Y Channel 4 Divider Dynamic Delay Control. Enables coarse frequency margining for divide value > 8 Y Channel 23 Divider Dynamic Delay Control. Enables coarse frequency margining for divide value > 8 Y Channel 01 Divider Dynamic Delay Control. Enables coarse frequency margining for divide value > 8 10.7.26 REFDETCTL Register; R25 The REFDETCTL register provides control over input reference clock detect features. Bit # Field [7:6] DETECT_MOD E_SEC[1:0] 82 Type Reset RW 0x1 NVM Y Description Secondary Input Energy Detector Mode Control. The DETECT_MODE_SEC field determines the method for Energy Detection on a single-ended signal on the Secondary Input as follows. When rising and/or falling slew rate detector is enabled, the reference input should meet the following conditions for correct operation: VIH > 1.7 V and VIL < 0.2 V. When VIH/VIL level detector is enabled, the reference input should meet the following conditions for correct operation: VIH > 1.5 V and VIL < 0.4 V. DETECT_MODE_SEC Energy Detection Method 0 Rising Slew Rate Detector 1 Rising and Falling Slew Rate Detector 2 Falling Slew Rate Detector 3 VIH/VIL Level Detector Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Bit # Field [5:4] DETECT_MOD E_PRI[1:0] Type Reset RW 0x1 NVM Y [3:2] LVL_SEL_SEC[ 1:0] RW 0x1 Y [1:0] LVL_SEL_PRI[1 RW :0] 0x1 Y Description Primary Input Energy Detector Mode Control. The DETECT_MODE_PRI field determines the method for Energy Detection on a single-ended signal on the Primary Input as follows. When rising and/or falling slew rate detector is enabled, the reference input should meet the following conditions for correct operation: VIH > 1.7 V and VIL < 0.2 V. When VIH/VIL level detector is enabled, the reference input should meet the following conditions for correct operation: VIH > 1.5 V and VIL < 0.4 V. DETECT_MODE_PRI Energy Detection Method 0 Rising Slew Rate Detector 1 Rising and Falling Slew Rate Detector 2 Falling Slew Rate Detector 3 VIH/VIL Level Detector Secondary Input Comparator Level Selection. The LVL_SEL_SEC fields determines the levels on a differential signal for the Secondary Input Energy Detection block as follows. LVL_SEL_SEC Comparator Levels 0 200 mV Differential 1 300 mV Differential 2 400 mV Differential 3 RESERVED Primary Input Comparator Level Selection. The LVL_SEL_PRI field determines the levels on a differential signal for the Primary Input Energy Detection block as follows. LVL_SEL_PRI Comparator Levels 0 200 mV Differential 1 300 mV Differential 2 400 mV Differential 3 RESERVED 10.7.27 STAT0_INT Register; R27 The STAT0_INT register provides control of the STATUS0 output and Interrupt configuration. The STATUS0 pin is also used for test and diagnostic functions. The test configuration registers override the STAT0_INT register. Bit # Field [7:4] STAT0_SEL[3:0] Type Reset NVM RW 0x5 Y Description STATUS0 Indicator Signal Select. STAT0CFG 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 The STATUS0 Information PRIREF Loss of Signal (LOS) SECREF Loss of Signal (LOS) PLL Loss of Lock (LOL) PLL R Divider, divided by 2 (when R Divider is not bypassed) PLL N Divider, divided by 2 Reserved Reserved Reserved PLL VCO Calibration Active (CAL) Reserved Interrupt (INTR). Derived from INT_FLAG register bits. PLL M Divider, divided by 2 (when M Divider is not bypassed) Reserved EEPROM Active PLL Secondary to Primary Switch in Automatic Mode Reserved polarity of STATUS0 is set by the STAT0POL bit. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 83 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Bit # Field [3] STAT0_POL Type Reset NVM RW 1 Y [2:0] - RSRVD - N www.ti.com Description STATUS0 Output Polarity. The STAT0_POL bit defines the polarity of information presented on the STATUS0 output. If STAT0_POL is set to 1 then STATUS0 is active high, if STAT0_POL is 0 then STATUS0 is active low. Reserved. 10.7.28 STAT1 Register; R28 The STAT1_INT register provides control of the STATUS1 output. The STATUS1 pin is also used for test and diagnostic functions. The test configuration registers override the STAT0 register. Bit # Field [7:4] STAT1_SEL[3:0] Type Reset NVM RW 0x2 Y [3] STAT1_POL RW 1 Y [2:0] RSRVD - - N 84 Description STATUS1 Indicator Signal Select. The STAT1_SEL field determines what information is presented on the STATUS1 output as follows. STAT1CFG STATUS1 Information 0 PRIREF Loss of Signal (LOS) 1 SECREF Loss of Signal (LOS) 2 PLL Loss of Lock (LOL) 3 PLL R Divider, divided by 2 (when R Divider is not bypassed) 4 PLL N Divider, divided by 2 5 Reserved 6 Reserved 7 Reserved 8 PLL VCO Calibration Active (CAL) 9 Reserved 10 Interrupt (INTR) 11 PLL M Divider, divided by 2 (when M Divider is not bypassed) 12 Reserved 13 EEPROM Active 14 PLL Secondary to Primary Switch in Automatic Mode 15 Reserved The polarity of STATUS1 is set by the STAT1POL bit. STATUS1 Output Polarity. The STAT1_POL bit defines the polarity of information presented on the STATUS1 output. If STAT1_POL is set to 1 then STATUS1 is active high, if STAT1_POL is 0 then STATUS1 is active low. Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.29 OSCCTL1 Register; R29 The OSCCTL1 register provides control over input reference clock features. Bit # Field [7] DETECT_BYP Type Reset RW 0 [6] [5] RSRVD TERM2GND_S EC TERM2GND_P RI DIFFTERM_SE C DIFFTERM_PRI RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 1 [1] AC_MODE_SE C RW 1 [0] AC_MODE_PRI RW 0 [4] [3] [2] NVM Description Y Signal Detector Bypass. When DETECT_BYP is 1 the output of the Signal Detector's, both Primary and Secondary are ingored and the inputs are always considered to be valid by the PLL control state machines. The DETECT_BYP bit has no effect on the Interrupt register or STATUS output's. N Reserved. Y Differential Termination to GND Control for Secondary Input. When TERM2GND_SEC is 1 an internal 50 Ω termination to GND is selected on the Secondary input in differential mode. Y Differential Termination to GND Control for Primary Input. When TERM2GND_PRI is 1 an internal 50 Ω termination to GND is selected on the Primary input in differential mode. Y Differential Termination Control for Secondary Input. When DIFFTERM_SEC is 1 an internal 100 Ω termination is selected on the Secondary input in differential mode. Y Differential Termination Control for Primary Input. When DIFFTERM_PRI is 1 an internal 100 Ω termination is selected on the Primary input in differential mode. Y AC Coupling Mode for Secondary Input. When AC_MODE_SEC is 1, this enables the internal input biasing to support an externally AC coupled input signal on the SECREF inputs. When AC_MODE_SEC is 0, the internal input bias is not used. Y AC Coupling Mode for Primary Input. When AC_MODE_PRI is 1, this enables the internal input biasing to support an externally AC coupled input signal on the PRIREF inputs. When AC_MODE_PRI is 0, the internal input bias is not used. 10.7.30 PWDN Register; R30 The PWDN register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7] [6] [5] RSRVD CMOSCHPWD N CH7PWDN [4] Type Rese NVM Description t N Reserved. RW 0 Y CMOS Output Channel Powerdown. RW 0 Y CH6PWDN RW 0 Y [3] CH5PWDN RW 0 Y [2] CH4PWDN RW 0 Y [1] CH23PWDN RW 0 Y [0] CH01PWDN RW 0 Y Output Channel 7 Powerdown. When CH7PWDN is 1, the MUX and divider of channel 7 will be disabled. To shut down entire output path (output MUX, divider and buffer), R43[5:4] should be set to 00 irrespective of R30.5. Output Channel 6 Powerdown. When CH6PWDN is 1, the MUX and divider of channel 6 will be disabled. To shut down entire output path (output MUX, divider and buffer), R41[5:4] should be set to 00 irrespective of R30.4. Output Channel 5 Powerdown. When CH5PWDN is 1, the MUX and divider of channel 5 will be disabled. To shut down entire output path (output MUX, divider and buffer), R39[5:4] should be set to 00 irrespective of R30.3. Output Channel 4 Powerdown. When CH4PWDN is 1, the MUX and divider of channel 4 will be disabled. To shut down entire output path (output MUX, divider and buffer), R37[5:4] should be set to 00 irrespective of R30.2. Output Channel 23 Powerdown. When CH23PWDN is 1, the MUX and divider of channels 2 and 3 will be disabled. To shut down entire output paths (output MUX, divider and buffers), R35[6:5] and R34[6:5] should be set to 00 irrespective of R30.1. Output Channel 01 Powerdown. When CH01PWDN is 1, the MUX and divider of channels 0 and 1 will be disabled. To shut down entire output paths (output MUX, divider and buffers), R32[6:5] and R31[6:5] should be set to 00 irrespective of R30.0. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 85 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.31 OUTCTL_0 Register; R31 The OUTCTL_0 register provides control over Output 0. Bit # Field Type Reset [7] RSRVD RW 1 [6:5] OUT_0_SEL[1:0 RW 0x1 ] [4:3] OUT_0_MODE1 RW [1:0] 0x2 [2:1] OUT_0_MODE2 RW [1:0] 0x0 [0] RSRVD - - NVM Description Y Reserved. It is recommended to be set to "0". Y Channel 0 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_0_SEL field controls the Channel 0 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_0_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/AC-LVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Y Channel 0 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_0_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Y Channel 0 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_0_MODE2 Diff-Mode, RLOAD in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity N Reserved. 10.7.32 OUTCTL_1 Register; R32 The OUTCTL_1 register provides control over Output 1. Bit # Field [7] RSRVD [6:5] OUT_1_SEL[1: 0] Type Reset NVM N RW 0x1 Y [4:3] OUT_1_MODE 1[1:0] RW 0x2 Y [2:1] OUT_1_MODE 2[1:0] RW 0x0 Y [0] RSRVD - - N 86 Description Reserved. Channel 1 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_1_SEL field controls the Channel 1 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_1_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/AC-LVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Channel 1 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_1_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Channel 1 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_1_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.33 OUTDIV_0_1 Register; R33 Channel [1:0] Output Divider Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] OUT_0_1_DIV RW 0x1 [7:0] NVM Description Y Channel's 0 and 1 Output Divider. The Channel 0 and 1 Divider, OUT_0_1_DIV, is a 8-bit divider. The valid values for OUT_0_1_DIV range from 1 to 256 as shown below. OUT_0_1_DIV DIVIDE RATIO 0 1 1 2 2 3 ... 255 256 10.7.34 OUTCTL_2 Register; R34 The OUTCTL_2 register provides control over Output 2. Bit # Field Type Reset [7] RSRVD RW 1 [6:5] OUT_2_SEL[1: RW 0x1 0] [4:3] OUT_2_MODE RW 1[1:0] 0x2 [2:1] OUT_2_MODE RW 2[1:0] 0x0 [0] RSRVD - - NVM Description Y Reserved. It is recommended to be set to "0". Y Channel 2 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_2_SEL field controls the Channel 2 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_2_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/AC-LVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Y Channel 2 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_2_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Y Channel 2 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_2_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity N Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 87 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.35 OUTCTL_3 Register; R35 The OUTCTL_3 register provides control over Output 3. Bit # Field Type Reset [7] RSRVD [6:5] OUT_3_SEL[1: RW 0x1 0] [4:3] OUT_3_MODE RW 1[1:0] 0x2 [2:1] OUT_3_MODE RW 2[1:0] 0x0 [0] RSRVD - - NVM Description N Reserved. Y Channel 3 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_3_SEL field controls the Channel 3 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_3_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/AC-LVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Y Channel 3 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_3_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Y Channel 3 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_3_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity N Reserved. 10.7.36 OUTDIV_2_3 Register; R36 Channel [3:2] Output Divider Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] OUT_2_3_DIV RW 0x3 [7:0] 88 NVM Description Y Channel's 2 and 3 Output Divider. The Channel 2 and 3 Divider, OUT_2_3_DIV, is a 8-bit divider. The valid values for OUT_2_3_DIV range from 1 to 256 as shown below. OUT_2_3_DIV DIVIDE RATIO 0 1 1 2 2 3 ... 255 256 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.37 OUTCTL_4 Register; R37 The OUTCTL_4 register provides control over Output 4 Bit # Field [7:6] CH_4_MUX[1: 0] Type Reset RW 0x0 [5:4] OUT_4_SEL[1: RW 0] 0x1 [3:2] OUT_4_MODE RW 1[1:0] 0x2 [1:0] OUT_4_MODE RW 2[1:0] 0x0 NVM Description Y Channel 4 Clock Source Mux Control. CH_4_MUX CH4 Clock Source 0 PLL 1 Reserved 2 PRIMARY REFERENCE 3 SECONDARY REFERENCE When the doubler is enabled the Primary and Secondary Reference options will reflect the frequency doubled reference. If the Primary or Secondary Reference options are selected the output divider is by-passed. Y Channel 4 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_4_SEL field controls the Channel 4 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_1_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/AC-LVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Y Channel 4 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_4_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Y Channel 4 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_4_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in CMOS=Mode, Out_N HCSL mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity 10.7.38 OUTDIV_4 Register; R38 Channel 4 Output Divider Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] OUT_4_DIV[7: RW 0x2 0] NVM Description Y Channel 4 Output Divider. The Channel 4 Divider, OUT_4_DIV, is a 8-bit divider. The valid values for OUT_4_DIV range from 1 to 256 as shown below. The divider only operates on Channel 4 when the clock source is PLL or PLL2. OUT_4_DIV DIVIDE RATIO 0 1 1 2 2 3 ... 255 256 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 89 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.39 OUTCTL_5 Register; R39 The OUTCTL_5 register provides control over Output 5. Bit # Field [7:6] CH_5_MUX[1: 0] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM Y [5:4] OUT_5_SEL[1: RW 0] 0x1 Y [3:2] OUT_5_MODE RW 1[1:0] 0x2 Y [1:0] OUT_5_MODE RW 2[1:0] 0x0 Y Description Channel 5 Clock Source Mux Control. CH_5_MUX CH5 Clock Source 0 PLL 1 Reserved 2 PRIMARY REFERENCE 3 SECONDARY REFERENCE When the doubler is enabled the Primary and Secondary Reference options will reflect the frequency doubled reference. If the Primary or Secondary Reference options are selected the output divider is by-passed. Channel 5 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_5_SEL field controls the Channel 5 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_1_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/ACLVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Channel 5 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_5_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Channel 5 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_5_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity 10.7.40 OUTDIV_5 Register; R40 Channel 5 Output Divider Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] OUT_5_DIV[7: RW 0x2 0] 90 NVM Y Description Channel 5 Output Divider. The Channel 5 Divider, OUT_5_DIV, is a 8-bit divider. The valid values for OUT_5_DIV range from 1 to 256 as shown below. The divider only operates on Channel 5 when the clock source is PLL or PLL2. OUT_5_DIV DIVIDE RATIO 0 1 1 2 2 3 ... 255 256 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.41 OUTCTL_6 Register; R41 The OUTCTL_6 register provides control over Output 6. Bit # Field [7:6] CH_6_MUX[ 1:0] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM Y [5:4] OUT_6_SEL[ RW 1:0] 0x1 Y [3:2] OUT_6_MO DE1[1:0] RW 0x2 Y [1:0] OUT_6_MO DE2[1:0] RW 0x0 Y Description Channel 6 Clock Source Mux Control. CH_6_MUX CH6 Clock Source 0 PLL 1 Reserved 2 PRIMARY REFERENCE 3 SECONDARY REFERENCE When the doubler is enabled the Primary and Secondary Reference options will reflect the frequency doubled reference. If the Primary or Secondary Reference options are selected the output divider is by-passed. Channel 6 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_6_SEL field controls the Channel 6 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_1_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/ACLVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Channel 6 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_6_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA Powerup, positive polarity (AC-LVPECL) Channel 6 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_6_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity 10.7.42 OUTDIV_6 Register; R42 Channel 6 Output Divider Bit # Field [7:0] OUT_6_DIV[ 7:0] Type Reset RW 0x5 NVM Y Description Channel 6 Output Divider. The Channel 6 Divider, OUT_6_DIV, is a 8-bit divider. The valid values for OUT_6_DIV range from 1 to 256 as shown below. The divider only operates on Channel 6 when the clock source is PLL or PLL2. OUT_6_DIV DIVIDE RATIO 0 1 1 2 2 3 ... 255 256 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 91 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.43 OUTCTL_7 Register; R43 The OUTCTL_7 register provides control over Output 7. Bit # Field [7:6] CH_7_MUX[ 1:0] Type RW Reset 0x0 NVM Y [5:4] OUT_7_SEL[ RW 1:0] 0x1 Y [3:2] OUT_7_MO DE1[1:0] RW 0x2 Y [1:0] OUT_7_MO DE2[1:0] RW 0x0 Y Description Channel 7 Clock Source Mux Control. CH_7_MUX CH7 Clock Source 0 PLL 1 Reserved 2 PRIMARY REFERENCE 3 SECONDARY REFERENCE When the doubler is enabled the Primary and Secondary Reference options will reflect the frequency doubled reference. If the Primary or Secondary Reference options are selected the output divider is by-passed. Channel 7 Output Driver Format Select. The OUT_7_SEL field controls the Channel 7 Output Driver as shown below. OUT_1_SEL OUTPUT OPERATION 0 Disabled 1 AC-LVDS/AC-CML/ACLVPECL 2 HCSL 3 LVCMOS Channel 7 Output Driver Mode1 Select. OUT_7_MODE1 Diff-Mode, Itail CMOS-Mode, Out_P 0 4 mA (AC-LVDS) Powerdown, tristate 1 6 mA (AC-CML) Powerdown, low 2 8 mA (AC-LVPECL) Powerup, negative polarity 3 16 mA (HCSL) or 8 mA (ACPowerup, positive polarity LVPECL) Channel 7 Output Driver Mode2 Select. OUT_7_MODE2 Diff-Mode, Rload in HCSL CMOS=Mode, Out_N mode 0 Tristate Powerdown, tristate 1 50 Ω Powerdown, low 2 100 Ω Powerup, negative polarity 3 200 Ω Powerup, positive polarity 10.7.44 OUTDIV_7 Register; R44 Channel 7 Output Divider Bit # Field [7:0] OUT_7_DIV[ 7:0] 92 Type RW Reset 0x5 NVM Y Description Channel 7 Output Divider. The Channel 7 Divider, OUT_7_DIV, is a 8-bit divider. The valid values for OUT_7_DIV range from 1 to 256 as shown below. The divider only operates on Channel 7 when the clock source is PLL or PLL2. OUT_7_DIV DIVIDE RATIO 0 1 1 2 2 3 ... 255 256 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.45 CMOSDIVCTRL Register; R45 CMOS Output Divider Control. The CMOS Clock Outputs provided on STATUS0 and STATUS1 can come from either CMOS Divider0 or CMOS Divider1. Additionally the clock source routed to the CMOS Dividers can come from either the PLL LVCMOS Pre-Divider or the PLL2 LVCMOS Pre-Divider. Bit # Field [7:6] RSRVD [5:4] PLLCMOSPR EDIV[1:0] Type Reset RW 0x0 RW 0x0 NVM Y Y [3:2] STATUS1MUX RW [1:0] 0x2 Y [1:0] STATUS0MUX RW [1:0] 0x2 Y Description Reserved. PLL LVCMOS Pre-Divider Selection. The PLLCMOSPREDIV field selects the divider value for the PLL pre-divider that drives the CMOS Dividers. PLLCMOSPREDIV Divider Value 0 Disabled 1 4 2 5 3 Reserved STATUS1 Mux Selection. The STATUS1MUX field controls the signal source for the STATUS1 Pin as described below. STATUS1MUX STATUS1 OPERATION 0 LVCMOS Clock, from STATUS0 Divider 1 LVCMOS Clock, from STATUS1 Divider 2 Normal Status Operation 3 STATUS1 Disabled STATUS0 Mux Selection. The STATUS0MUX field controls the signal source for the STATUS0 Pin as described below. STATUS0MUX STATUS0 OPERATION 0 LVCMOS Clock, from STATUS0 Divider 1 LVCMOS Clock, from STATUS1 Divider 2 Normal Status Operation 3 STATUS0 Disabled 10.7.46 CMOSDIV0 Register; R46 CMOS Output Divider 0 Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] CMOSDIV0[7 RW 0x0 :0] NVM Y Description CMOS Output Divider 0. The CMOS Divider0, CMOSDIV0, is a 8-bit divider that divides the clock source from the PLL LVCMOS Pre-Divider output. The valid values for CMOSDIV0 range from 1 to 256 as shown below. CMOSDIV0 DIVIDE RATIO 0 Disabled 1..5 6 6 7 7 8 ... 255 256 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 93 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.47 STATUS_SLEW Register; R49 Status CMOS Output Slew Control Bit # Field [7:4] RSRVD [3:2] STATUS1SL EW[1:0] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM N Y [1:0] RW Y STATUS0SL EW[1:0] 0x0 Description Reserved. STATUS1 Slew Control. The STATUS1SLEW field controls the slew rate of the STATUS1 output as shown below. STATUS1SLEW STATUS1 Rise/Fall Time 0 Fast (0.35 ns) 1 RESERVED 2 Slow (2.1 ns) 3 RESERVED STATUS0 Slew Control. The STATUS0SLEW field controls the slew rate of the STATUS0 output as shown below. STATUS0SLEW STATUS0 Rise/Fall Time 0 Fast (0.35 ns) 1 RESERVED 2 Slow (2.1 ns) 3 RESERVED 10.7.48 IPCLKSEL Register; R50 Input Clock Select Bit # Field Type Reset [7:6] SECBUFSEL RW 0x2 [1:0] NVM Y [5:4] PRIBUFSEL[ 1:0] RW 0x1 Y [3:2] [1:0] RSRVD RW INSEL_PLL[1 RW :0] 0x1 0x1 Y Y 94 Description Secondary Input Buffer Selection. SECBUFSEL configures the Secondary Input Buffer as follows. SECBUFSEL Mode b00 Single-ended Input b01 Differential Input b10 Crystal Input b11 Disabled Primary Input Buffer Selection. PRIBUFSEL configures the Primary Input Buffer as follows. PRIBUFSEL Mode b00 Single-ended Input b01 Differential Input b10 Disabled b11 Disabled Reserved. Reference Input Selection for PLL. INSEL_PLL Determines the input select for PLL as follows. INSEL_PLL Input Mode b00 Automatic, Primary is preferred. b01 Determined by external pin, REFSEL. b10 Primary Input Selected. b11 Secondary Input Selected. When INSEL_PLL is equal to b01 the REFSEL pin determines the reference clock source for PLL as follows. REFSEL PLL Reference Clock 0 PLL Reference is Primary input VIM PLL Reference is Secondary input 1 PLL Input MUX is set to Automatic Mode Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.49 IPCLKCTL Register; R51 Input Clock Control Bit # Field Type Reset [7] CLKMUX_BY RW 0 PASS NVM Y [6:3] [2] RSRVD RW SECONSWIT RW CH 0x0 0 Y Y [1] SECBUFGAI N RW 1 Y [0] PRIBUFGAIN RW 1 Y Description Clock Mux Bypass. Controls whether the glitch-less clock mux on the the Primary and Secondary Reference paths is enabled. When CLKMUX_BYPASS is 1 then the clock mux is by-passed. Reserved. Secondary Crystal Input Buffer On after Switch. Determines whether the Secondary Crystal Input Buffer remains on after a switch back to the Primary Input. If SECONSWITCH is 0 then the Secomdary Crystal Input Buffer is disabled after a switch back to the Primary input. If SECONSWITCH is 1 then the Secondary Crystal Input Buffer remains active after a switch back to the Primary input. Secondary Input Buffer Gain. SECBUFGAIN GAIN 0 Minimum 1 Maximum Primary Input Buffer Gain. PRIBUFGAIN GAIN 0 Minimum 1 Maximum 10.7.50 PLL_RDIV Register; R52 R Divider for PLL Bit # Field [7:3] RSRVD [2:0] PLLRDIV[2:0 ] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM N Y Description Reserved. PLL R Divider. PLL R Divider ratio is set by PLLRDIV. PLLRDIV PLL R-Divider Value 0 Bypass 1 2 ... ... 7 8 10.7.51 PLL_MDIV Register; R53 M Divider for PLL Bit # Field Type Reset [7:5] RSRVD [4:0] PLLMDIV[4:0 RW 0x0 ] NVM N Y Description Reserved. PLL M Divider. PLL M Divider ratio is set by PLLMDIV. PLLMDIV PLL M-Divider Value 0 Bypass 1 2 ... ... 31 32 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 95 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.52 PLL_CTRL0 Register; R56 The PLL_CTRL0 register provides control of PLL. The PLL_CTRL0 register fields are described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:5] RSRVD [4:2] PLL_P[2:0] Type Reset RW 0x7 NVM N Y [1] RW 1 Y RW 0 Y [0] PLL_SYNC_ EN PLL_PDN Description Reserved. PLL Post-Divider. The PLL_P field selects the PLL post-divider value as follows. PLL_P Post Divider Value 0 2 1 2 2 3 3 4 4 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 PLL SYNC Enable. If PLL_SYNC_EN is 1 then a SYNC event will cause all channels which use PLL as a clock source to be re-synchronized. PLL Powerdown. The PLL_PDN bit determines whether PLL is automatically enabled and calibrated after a hardware reset. If the PLL_PDN bit is set to 1 during normal operation then PLL is disabled and the calibration circuit is reset. When PLL_PDN is then cleared to 0 PLL is re-enabled and the calibration sequence is automatically restarted. PLL_PDN PLL STATE 0 PLL Enabled 1 PLL Disabled 10.7.53 PLL_CTRL1 Register; R57 The PLL_CTRL1 register provides control of PLL. The PLL_CTRL1 register fields are described in the following table. Bit # [7:6] [5] [4] Field RSRVD RSRVD PRI_D Type RW RW Reset 0 1 NVM N Y Y [3:0] PLL_CP[3:0] RW 0x8 Y 96 Description Reserved. Reserved. Primary Reference Doubler Enable. If PRI_D is 1 the Primary Input Frequency Doubler is enabled. PLL Charge Pump Gain. The PLL_CP sets the chargepump current as follows. PLL_CP Icp (mA) b0001 0.4 b0010 0.8 b0100 1.6 b1000 6.4 b0011 1.2 b0101 2.0 b0110 2.4 b0111 2.8 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.54 PLL_NDIV_BY1 Register; R58 The 12-bit N integer divider value for PLL is set by the PLL_NDIV_BY1 and PLL_NDIV_BY0 registers. Bit # Field [7:4] RSRVD [3:0] PLL_NDIV[ 11:8] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM N Y Description Reserved. PLL N Divider Byte 1. PLL Integer N Divider bits 11 to 8. PLL_NDIV DIVIDER RATIO 0 1 1 1 ... ... 4095 4095 10.7.55 PLL_NDIV_BY0 Register; R59 The PLL_NDIV_BY0 register is described in the following table. Bit Field Type Reset # [7:0 PLL_NDIV[7:0] RW 0x66 ] NVM Description Y PLL N Divider Byte 0. PLL Integer N Divider bits 7 to 0. 10.7.56 PLL_FRACNUM_BY2 Register; R60 The Fractional Divider Numerator value for PLL is set by registers PLL_FRACNUM_BY2, PLL_FRACNUM_BY1 and PLL_FRACNUM_BY0. Bit # [7:6 ] [5:0 ] Field Type Reset NVM Description RSRVD - - N Reserved. PLL_NUM[21: 16] RW 0x0 Y PLL Fractional Divider Numerator Byte 2. Bits 21 to 16. 10.7.57 PLL_FRACNUM_BY1 Register; R61 The PLL_FRACNUM_BY1 register is described in the following table. Bit Field # [7:0 PLL_NUM[15: ] 8] Type Reset NVM Description RW Y 0x0 PLL Fractional Divider Numerator Byte 1. Bits 15 to 8. 10.7.58 PLL_FRACNUM_BY0 Register; R62 The PLL_FRACNUM_BY0 register is described in the following table. Bit Field Type Reset # [7:0 PLL_NUM[7:0] RW 0x0 ] NVM Description Y PLL Fractional Divider Numerator Byte 0. Bits 7 to 0. 10.7.59 PLL_FRACDEN_BY2 Register; R63 The Fractional Divider Denominator value for PLL is set by registers PLL_FRACDEN_BY2, PLL_FRACDEN_BY1 and PLL_FRACDEN_BY0. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:6] RSRVD [5:0] PLL_DEN[21: RW 0x0 16] NVM Description N Reserved. Y PLL Fractional Divider Denominator Byte 2. Bits 21 to 16. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 97 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.60 PLL_FRACDEN_BY1 Register; R64 The PLL_FRACDEN_BY1 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] PLL_DEN[1 RW 0x0 5:8] NVM Y Description PLL Fractional Divider Denominator Byte 1. Bits 15 to 8. 10.7.61 PLL_FRACDEN_BY0 Register; R65 The PLL_FRACDEN_BY0 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:0] PLL_DEN[7: 0] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM Description Y PLL Fractional Divider Denominator Byte 0. Bits 7 to 0. 10.7.62 PLL_MASHCTRL Register; R66 The PLL_MASHCTRL register provides control of the fractional divider for PLL. Bit # Field [7:4] RSRVD [3:2] PLL_DTHR MODE[1:0] Type Reset RW 0x3 [1:0] RW PLL_ORDE R[1:0] 0x0 NVM N Y Description Reserved. Mash Engine dither mode control. DITHERMODE 00 01 10 11 Mash Engine Order. ORDER 00 01 10 11 Y Dither Configuration Weak Medium Strong Dither Disabled Order Configuration Integer Mode Divider 1st order 2nd order 3rd order 10.7.63 PLL_LF_R2 Register; R67 The PLL_LF_R2 register controls the value of the PLL Loop Filter R2. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:6] RSRVD [5:0] PLL_LF_R2 RW 0x24 [5:0] NVM N Y Description Reserved. PLL Loop Filter R2. NOTE: Table below lists commonly used R2 values but more selections are available. PLL_LF_R2[5:0] R2 (Ω) b000001 236 b000010 336 b000100 536 b001000 735 b100000 1636 B110000 2418 10.7.64 PLL_LF_C1 Register; R68 The PLL_LF_C1 register controls the value of the PLL Loop Filter C1. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:3] RSRVD [2:0] PLL_LF_C RW 0x0 1[2:0] 98 NVM Description N Reserved. Y PLL Loop Filter C1. The value in pF is given by 5 + 50 * PLL_LF_C1 (in binary). Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.65 PLL_LF_R3 Register; R69 The PLL_LF_R3 register controls the value of the PLL Loop Filter R3. Bit # Field Type Reset [7] RSRVD [6:0] PLL_LF_R RW 0x0 3[6:0] NVM Description N Reserved. Y PLL Loop Filter R3. NOTE: Table below lists commonly used R3 values but more selections are available. PLL_LF_R3[6:0] R3 (Ω) b0000000 18 b0000010 318 b0000100 518 b0001000 717 b0010000 854 b0100000 1654 b1000000 3254 10.7.66 PLL_LF_C3 Register; R70 The PLL_LF_C3 register controls the value of the PLL Loop Filter C3. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:3] RSRVD [2:0] PLL_LF_C RW 0x0 3[2:0] NVM Description N Reserved. Y PLL Loop Filter C3. The value in pF is given by 5 * PLL_LF_C3 (in binary). 10.7.67 SEC_CTRL Register; R72 The SEC_CTRL register controls the value of the Secondary Reference Doubler. Bit # [7:6] [5] [4] Field RSRVD RSRVD SEC_D Type RW RW Reset 0 1 NVM N Y Y [3:0] RSRVD RW 0x8 Y Description Reserved. Reserved. Secondary Reference Doubler Enable. If SEC_D is 1 the Secondary Input Frequency Doubler is enabled. Reserved. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 99 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.68 XO_MARGINING Register; R86 Margin Control Bit # Field Type Reset [7] RSRVD [6:4] MARGIN R 0x0 _DIG_ST EP[2:0] NVM N N [3:2] MARGIN _OPTIO N[1:0] RW 0x0 Y [1:0] RSRVD - - Description Reserved. Margin Digital Step. MARGIN_DIG_STEP allows the current level of the margin selection pin (GPIO[5]) to be read. MARGIN_DIG_STEP Value 0 STEP1 1 STEP2 2 STEP3 3 STEP4. (Nominal loading for zero frequency offset 4 STEP5 5 STEP6 6 STEP7 7 STEP8 Margin Option Select. The MARGIN_OPTION field defines the operation of the Frequency Margining as follows. MARGIN_OPTIONS MARGIN Mode 0 Margining Enabled when GPIO4 pin is low. GPIO5 pin selects the frequency offset setting (STEP1 to STEP8). When GPIO4 pin is high, STEP4 offset value is selected to use the nominal crystal loading. 1 Margining Enabled. GPIO5 pin selects the frequency offset setting (STEP1 to STEP8). GPIO4 pin state is ignored. 2 Margining Enabled. Frequency offset is controlled by XOOFFSET_SW register bits (R104 and R105). N Reserved. 10.7.69 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_1_BY1 Register; R88 XO Margining Step 1 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_STE RW 0x0 P1[9:8] NVM N Y Description Reserved. XO Margining Step 1 Offset Value. 10.7.70 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_1_BY0 Register; R89 XO Margining Step 1 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0xDE EP1[7:0] NVM Y Description XO Margining Step 1 Offset Value. 10.7.71 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_2_BY1 Register; R90 XO Margining Step 1 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0x1 EP2[9:8] 100 NVM N Y Description Reserved. XO Margining Step 2 Offset Value. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.72 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_2_BY0 Register; R91 XO Margining Step 2 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0x18 EP2[7:0] NVM Y Description XO Margining Step 2 Offset Value. 10.7.73 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_3_BY1 Register; R92 XO Margining Step 3 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0x1 EP3[9:8] NVM N Y Description Reserved. XO Margining Step 3 Offset Value. 10.7.74 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_3_BY0 Register; R93 XO Margining Step 3 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0x4B EP3[7:0] NVM Y Description XO Margining Step 3 Offset Value. 10.7.75 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_4_BY1 Register; R94 XO Margining Step 4 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0x1 EP4[9:8] NVM N Y Description Reserved. XO Margining Step 4 Offset Value. 10.7.76 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_4_BY0 Register; R95 XO Margining Step 4 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST EP4[7:0] Type Reset RW 0x86 NVM Description Y XO Margining Step 4 Offset Value. 10.7.77 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_5_BY1 Register; R96 XO Margining Step 5 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field Type Reset [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW 0x1 EP5[9:8] NVM N Y Description Reserved. XO Margining Step 5 Offset Value. 10.7.78 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_5_BY0 Register; R97 XO Margining Step 5 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field Type [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW EP5[7:0] Reset 0xBE NVM Y Description XO Margining Step 5 Offset Value. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 101 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.79 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_6_BY1 Register; R98 XO Margining Step 6 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST EP6[9:8] Type Reset RW 0x1 NVM Description N Reserved. Y XO Margining Step 6 Offset Value. 10.7.80 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_6_BY0 Register; R99 XO Margining Step 6 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST EP6[7:0] Type Reset RW 0xFE NVM Description Y XO Margining Step 6 Offset Value. 10.7.81 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_7_BY1 Register; R100 XO Margining Step 7 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST EP7[9:8] Type Reset RW 0x2 NVM Description N Reserved. Y XO Margining Step 7 Offset Value. 10.7.82 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_7_BY0 Register; R101 XO Margining Step 7 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST EP7[7:0] Type Reset RW 0x47 NVM Description Y XO Margining Step 7 Offset Value. 10.7.83 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_8_BY1 Register; R102 XO Margining Step 8 Offset Value (bits 9-8) Bit # Field Type [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW EP8[9:8] Reset 0x2 NVM Description N Reserved. Y XO Margining Step 8 Offset Value. 10.7.84 XO_OFFSET_GPIO5_STEP_8_BY0 Register; R103 XO Margining Step 8 Offset Value (bits 7-0) Bit # Field Type [7:0] XOOFFSET_ST RW EP8[7:0] Reset 0x9E NVM Description Y XO Margining Step 8 Offset Value. 10.7.85 XO_OFFSET_SW_BY1 Register; R104 Software Controlled XO Margining Offset Value (bits 9-8). Bit # Field [7:2] RSRVD [1:0] XOOFFSET_S W[9:8] 102 Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM Description N Reserved. Y XO Margining Software Controlled Offset Value. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.86 XO_OFFSET_SW_BY0 Register; R105 Software Controlled XO Margining Offset Value (bits 7-0). Bit # Field [7:0] XOOFFSET_S W[7:0] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM Description Y XO Margining Software Controlled Offset Value. 10.7.87 PLL_CTRL2 Register; R117 The PLL_CTRL2 register provides control of PLL. The PLL_CTRL2 register fields are described in the following table. Bit # Field [7] PLL_STRET CH Type Reset RW 0 [6:0] - RSRVD - NVM Description Y Stretch PFD minimum pump width in fractional mode. A value of 0 is recommended for Integer-N PLL and sets the phase detector pulse width to 200 ps. A value of 1 is recommended for Fractional-N PLL and stretches the pulse width to roughly 600 ps. N Reserved. 10.7.88 PLL_CTRL3 Register; R118 The PLL_CTRL3 register provides control of PLL. The PLL_CTRL3 register fields are described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:3] RSRVD [2:0] PLL_DISABL E_4TH[2:0] Type Reset RW 0x3 NVM Description N Reserved. Y PLL Loop Filter Settings. PLL_DISABLE_4TH[2:0] 0, 1, 2 3 4, 5, 6 7 MODE RESERVED 2nd Order Loop Filter Recommended Setting for Integer PLL Mode. RESERVED 3rd Order Loop Filter Recommended Setting for Fractional PLL Mode. 10.7.89 PLL_CALCTRL0 Register; R119 The PLL_CALCTRL0 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:4] RSRVD [3:2] PLL_CLSDW AIT[1:0] [1:0] Type Reset RW 0x0 PLL_VCOWA RW IT[1:0] 0x1 NVM Description N Reserved. Y Closed Loop Wait Period. The CLSDWAIT field sets the closed loop wait period, in periods of the always on clock as follows. Use 0x1 for clock generator mode (> 10 kHz loop bandwidth) and 0x3 for jitter cleaner mode (< 1 kHz loop bandwidth). CLSDWAIT Analog closed loop VCO stabilization time 0 30 us 1 300 us 2 30 ms 3 300 ms Y VCO Wait Period. Use 0x1 for all modes. VCOWAIT VCO stabilization time 0 20 us 1 400 us 2 8000 us 3 200000 us Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 103 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.90 PLL_CALCTRL1 Register; R120 The PLL_CALCTRL1 register is described in the following table. Bit # Field [7:1] RSRVD [0] PLL_LOOPB W Type Reset RW 0 NVM Description N Reserved. Y PLL Loop bandwidth Control. When PLL_LOOPBW is 1 the loop bandwidth of PLL is reduced to 200 Hz (jitter cleaner mode). When PLL_LOOPBW is 0 the loop bandwidth of PLL is set to its normal range (clock generator mode). NOTE: Proper PLL settings need to be utilized (PFD, charge pump, loop filter) with setting the desired value for PLL_LOOPBW. 10.7.91 NVMCNT Register; R136 The NVMCNT register is intended to reflect the number of on-chip EEPROM Erase/Program cycles that have taken place in EEPROM. The count is automatically incremented by hardware and stored in EEPROM. Bit # Field Type Reset [7:0] NVMCNT[7:0 R 0x0 ] NVM Description Y NVM Program Count. The NVMCNT increments automatically after every EEPROM Erase/Program Cycle. The NVMCNT value is retreived automatically after reset, after a NVM Commit operation or after a Erase/Program cycle. The NVMCNT register will increment until it reaches its maximum value of 255 after which no further increments will take place. 10.7.92 NVMCTL Register; R137 The NVMCTL register allows control of the on-chip EEPROM Memories. Bit # Field [7] RSRVD [6] REGCOMMI T Type Reset RWS 0 C [5] NVMCRCER R NVMAUTOC RC NVMCOMMI T R 0 RW 1 [2] NVMBUSY R [1] RSRVD [0] NVMPROG RWS 0 C RWS 0 C [4] [3] RWS 0 C 0 NVM Description N Reserved. N REG Commit to NVM SRAM Array. The REGCOMMIT bit is used to initiate a transfer from the on-chip registers back to the corresponding location in the NVM SRAM Array. The REGCOMMIT bit is automatically cleared to 0 when the transfer is complete. The particular page of SRAM used as the destination for the transfer is selected by the REGCOMMIT_PAGE register. N NVM CRC Error Indication. The NVMCRCERR bit is set to 1 if a CRC Error has been detected when reading back from on-chip EEPROM during device configuration. N NVM Automatic CRC. When NVMAUTOCRC is 1 then the EEPROM Stored CRC byte is automatically calculated whenever an EEPROM program takes place. N NVM Commit to Registers. The NVMCOMMIT bit is used to initiate a transfer of the on-chip EEPROM contents to internal registers. The transfer happens automatically after reset or when NVMCOMMIT is set to 1. The NVMCOMMIT bit is automatically cleared to 0. The I2C registers cannot be read while a NVM Commit operation is taking place. The NVMCOMMIT operation can only carried out when the Always On Clock is active. The Always On Clock can be kept running after lock by setting the AONAFTERLOCK bit. N NVM Program Busy Indication. The NVMBUSY bit is 1 during an on-chip EEPROM Erase/Program cycle. While NVMBUSY is 1 the on-chip EEPROM cannot be accessed. N Reserved. N NVM Program Start. The NVMPROG bit is used to begin an on-chip EEPROM Erase/Program cycle. The Erase/Program cycle is only initiated if the immediately preceding I2C transaction was a write to the NVMUNLK register with the appropriate code. The NVMPROG bit is automatically cleared to 0. The NVM Erase/Program operation takes around 230 ms. 10.7.93 NVMLCRC Register; R138 The NVMLCRC register holds the Live CRC byte that has been calculated while reading on-chip EEPROM. Bit # Field [7:0] NVMLCRC[ 7:0] 104 Type Reset R 0x0 NVM Description N NVM Live CRC. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.7.94 MEMADR_BY1 Register; R139 The MEMADR_BY1 register holds the MSB of the starting address for on-chip SRAM or EEPROM access. Bit # Field [7:4] RSRVD [3:0] MEMADR[1 1:8] Type Reset RW 0x0 NVM Description N Reserved. N Memory Address. The MEMADR value determines the starting address for access to the onchip memories. The on-chip memories and the corresponding address ranges are listed below. The data from the selected address is then accessed using one of the data registers listed below. MEMORY MEMADR Range Data Register NVM EEPROM-Array MEMADR[8:0] NVMDAT NVM SRAM-Array MEMADR[8:0] RAMDAT ROM-Array MEMADR[11:0] ROMDAT 10.7.95 MEMADR_BY0 Register; R140 The MEMADR_BY0 register holds the lower 8-bits of the starting address for on-chip SRAM or EEPROM access. Bit # [7:0] Field Type MEMADR[7 RW :0] Reset 0x0 NVM Description N Memory Address. 10.7.96 NVMDAT Register; R141 The NVMDAT register returns the on-chip EEPROM contents from the starting address specified by the MEMADR register. Bit # [7:0] Field Type NVMDAT[7: R 0] Reset 0x0 NVM Description N EEPROM Read Data. The first time an I2C read transaction accesses the NVMDAT register address, either because it was explicitly targeted or because the address was autoincremented, the read transaction will return the EEPROM data located at the address specified by the MEMADR register. Any additional read's which are part of the same transaction will cause the EEPROM address to be incremented and the next EEPROM data byte will be returned. The I2C address will no longer be auto-incremented, i.e the I2C address will be locked to the NVMDAT register after the first access. Access to the NVMDAT register will terminate at the end of the current I2C transaction. 10.7.97 RAMDAT Register; R142 The RAMDAT register provides read and write access to the SRAM that forms part of the on-chip EEPROM module. Bit # [7:0] Field Type RAMDAT[7: RW 0] Reset 0x0 NVM Description N RAM Read/Write Data. The first time an I2C read or write transaction accesses the RAMDAT register address, either because it was explicitly targeted or because the address was autoincremented, a read transaction will return the RAM data located at the address specified by the MEMADR register and a write transaction will cause the current I2C data to be written to the address specified by the MEMADR register. Any additional accesses which are part of the same transaction will cause the RAM address to be incremented and a read or write access will take place to the next SRAM address. The I2C address will no longer be autoincremented, i.e the I2C address will be locked to the RAMDAT register after the first access. Access to the RAMDAT register will terminate at the end of the current I2Cs transaction. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 105 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 10.7.98 ROMDAT Register; R143 The romdat register provides read to the on-chip ROM module. Bit # [7:0] Field Type ROMDAT[7: R 0] Reset 0x0 NVM Description N ROM Read Data. The first time an I2C read or write transaction accesses the romdat register address, either because it was explicitly targeted or because the address was autoincremented, a read transaction will return the ROM data located at the address specified by the MEMADR register. Any additional accesses which are part of the same transaction will cause the ROM address to be incremented and a read access will take place to the next ROM address. The I2C address will no longer be auto-incremented, i.e the I2C address will be locked to the romdat register after the first access. Access to the ROMDAT register will terminate at the end of the current I2C transaction. 10.7.99 NVMUNLK Register; R144 The NVMUNLK register provides a rudimentary level of protection to prevent inadvertent programming of the onchip EEPROM. Bit # [7:0] Field NVMUNLK[ 7:0] Type RW Reset 0x0 NVM Description N NVM Prog Unlock. The NVMUNLK register must be written immediately prior to setting the NVMPROG bit of register NVMCTL, otherwise the Erase/Program cycle will not be triggered. NVMUNLK must be written with a value of 0xEA. 10.7.100 REGCOMMIT_PAGE Register; R145 The REGCOMMIT_PAGE register determines the region of the EEPROM/SRAM array that is populated by the REGCOMMIT operation. Bit # [7:4] [3:0] Field Type RSRVD REGCOMM RW IT_PG[3:0] Reset 0x0 NVM N N Description Reserved. Register Commit Page (1 of 6 available pages that can be selected by the GPIO[3:2] pins for default powerup state. NOTE: Valid page values are 0 to 5. Do not use other values.) 10.7.101 XOCAPCTRL_BY1 Register; R199 The XOCAPCTRL_BY1 and XOCAPCTRL_BY0 registers allow read-back of the XOCAPCTRL value that displays the on-chip load capacitance selected for the crystal. Bit # [7:2] [1:0] Field Type RSRVD XO_CAP_C R TRL[9:8] Reset 0x0 NVM N N Description Reserved. XO CAP CTRL register. 10.7.102 XOCAPCTRL_BY0 Register; R200 The XOCAPCTRL_BY1 and XOCAPCTRL_BY0 registers allow read-back of the XOCAPCTRL value that displays the on-chip load capacitance selected for the crystal. Bit # [7:0] 106 Field Type XO_CAP_C R TRL[7:0] Reset 0x0 NVM Description N XO CAP CTRL register. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 10.8 EEPROM Map The EEPROM map is shown in the table below. There are 6 EEPROM pages and the common EEPROM bits are shown first. Any bit that is labeled as "RSRVD" should be written with a "0". Byte # Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 0 PRTID[31] PRTID[30] PRTID[29] PRTID[28] PRTID[27] PRTID[26] PRTID[25] PRTID[24] 1 PRTID[23] PRTID[22] PRTID[21] PRTID[20] PRTID[19] PRTID[18] PRTID[17] PRTID[16] 2 PRTID[15] PRTID[14] PRTID[13] PRTID[12] PRTID[11] PRTID[10] PRTID[9] PRTID[8] 3 PRTID[7] PRTID[6] PRTID[5] PRTID[4] PRTID[3] PRTID[2] PRTID[1] PRTID[0] 4 NVMSCRC[7] NVMSCRC[6] NVMSCRC[5] NVMSCRC[4] NVMSCRC[3] NVMSCRC[2] NVMSCRC[1] NVMSCRC[0] 5 NVMCNT[7] NVMCNT[6] NVMCNT[5] NVMCNT[4] NVMCNT[3] NVMCNT[2] NVMCNT[1] NVMCNT[0] 11 SLAVEADR_GPIO 1_SW[7] SLAVEADR_GPIO1_ SLAVEADR_GPIO1_ SLAVEADR_GPIO1_ SLAVEADR_GPIO1_ RSRVD SW[6] SW[5] SW[4] SW[3] RSRVD RSRVD 12 EEREV[7] EEREV[6] EEREV[5] EEREV[4] EEREV[3] EEREV[2] EEREV[1] EEREV[0] 13 SYNC_AUTO SYNC_MUTE AONAFTERLOCK PLLSTRTMODE AUTOSTRT LOL_MASK LOS_MASK CAL_MASK 14 1 1 1 SECTOPRI_MASK 1 LOL_POL LOS_POL CAL_POL 15 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD SECTOPRI_POL RSRVD INT_AND_OR INT_EN STAT1_SHOOT_T HRU_LIMIT 16 STAT0_SHOOT_T HRU_LIMIT RSRVD RSRVD STAT1_OPEND STAT0_OPEND CH3_MUTE_LVL[1] CH3_MUTE_LVL[0] CH2_MUTE_LVL[1 ] 17 CH2_MUTE_LVL[0 CH1_MUTE_LVL[1] ] CH1_MUTE_LVL[0] CH0_MUTE_LVL[1] CH0_MUTE_LVL[0] CH7_MUTE_LVL[1] CH7_MUTE_LVL[0] CH6_MUTE_LVL[1 ] 18 CH6_MUTE_LVL[0 CH5_MUTE_LVL[1] ] CH5_MUTE_LVL[0] CH4_MUTE_LVL[1] CH4_MUTE_LVL[0] CH_7_MUTE CH_6_MUTE CH_5_MUTE 19 CH_4_MUTE CH_3_MUTE CH_2_MUTE CH_1_MUTE CH_0_MUTE STATUS1_MUTE STATUS0_MUTE DIV_7_DYN_DLY 20 DIV_6_DYN_DLY DIV_5_DYN_DLY DIV_4_DYN_DLY DIV_23_DYN_DLY DIV_01_DYN_DLY DETECT_MODE_SE DETECT_MODE_SE DETECT_MODE_ C[1] C[0] PRI[1] 21 DETECT_MODE_ PRI[0] LVL_SEL_SEC[1] LVL_SEL_SEC[0] LVL_SEL_PRI[1] LVL_SEL_PRI[0] RSRVD 22 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP 9] 8] 7] 6] 1[5] 23 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP1[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP 1[4] 3] 2] 1] 0] 9] 8] 2[7] 24 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP2[ XOOFFSET_STEP 2[6] 5] 4] 3] 2] 1] 0] 3[9] 25 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP3[ XOOFFSET_STEP3[ XOOFFSET_STEP3[ XOOFFSET_STEP3[ XOOFFSET_STEP3[ XOOFFSET_STEP3[ XOOFFSET_STEP 3[8] 7] 6] 5] 4] 3] 2] 3[1] 26 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP 3[0] 9] 8] 7] 6] 5] 4] 5[3] RSRVD RSRVD Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 107 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com EEPROM Map (continued) Byte # Bit7 27 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP5[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP 5[2] 1] 0] 9] 8] 7] 6] 6[5] Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 28 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP6[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP 6[4] 3] 2] 1] 0] 9] 8] 7[7] 29 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP7[ XOOFFSET_STEP 7[6] 5] 4] 3] 2] 1] 0] 8[9] 30 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP8[ XOOFFSET_STEP8[ XOOFFSET_STEP8[ XOOFFSET_STEP8[ XOOFFSET_STEP8[ XOOFFSET_STEP8[ XOOFFSET_STEP 8[8] 7] 6] 5] 4] 3] 2] 8[1] 31 XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_SW[9] 8[0] XOOFFSET_SW[8] XOOFFSET_SW[7] XOOFFSET_SW[6] XOOFFSET_SW[5] XOOFFSET_SW[4] XOOFFSET_SW[3 ] 32 XOOFFSET_SW[2 ] XOOFFSET_SW[1] XOOFFSET_SW[0] RSRVD RSRVD 1 RSRVD 1 33 1 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 1 34 1 RSRVD RSRVD 1 1 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 35 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 1 1 RSRVD RSRVD 1 36 RSRVD 1 RSRVD 1 RSRVD RSRVD 1 RSRVD 37 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 38 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD EEPROM_PAGE=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 39, 90, RSRVD 141, 192, 243, 294 OUT_0_SEL[1] OUT_0_SEL[0] OUT_0_MODE1[1] OUT_0_MODE1[0] OUT_0_MODE2[1] OUT_0_MODE2[0] OUT_1_SEL[1] 40, 91, OUT_1_SEL[0] 142, 193, 244, 295 OUT_1_MODE1[1] OUT_1_MODE1[0] OUT_1_MODE2[1] OUT_1_MODE2[0] OUT_0_1_DIV[7] OUT_0_1_DIV[6] OUT_0_1_DIV[5] 41, 92, OUT_0_1_DIV[4] 143, 194, 245, 296 OUT_0_1_DIV[3] OUT_0_1_DIV[2] OUT_0_1_DIV[1] OUT_0_1_DIV[0] RSRVD OUT_2_SEL[1] OUT_2_SEL[0] 42, 93, OUT_2_MODE1[1] OUT_2_MODE1[0] 144, 195, 246, 297 OUT_2_MODE2[1] OUT_2_MODE2[0] OUT_3_SEL[1] OUT_3_SEL[0] OUT_3_MODE1[1] OUT_3_MODE1[0] 43, 94, OUT_3_MODE2[1] OUT_3_MODE2[0] 145, 196, 247, 298 OUT_2_3_DIV[7] OUT_2_3_DIV[6] OUT_2_3_DIV[5] OUT_2_3_DIV[4] OUT_2_3_DIV[3] OUT_2_3_DIV[2] 44, 95, OUT_2_3_DIV[1] 146, 197, 248, 299 CH_4_MUX[1] CH_4_MUX[0] OUT_4_SEL[1] OUT_4_SEL[0] OUT_4_MODE1[1] OUT_4_MODE1[0] OUT_4_DIV[7] OUT_4_DIV[6] OUT_4_DIV[5] OUT_4_DIV[4] OUT_4_DIV[3] OUT_4_DIV[2] OUT_2_3_DIV[0] 45, 96, OUT_4_MODE2[1] OUT_4_MODE2[0] 147, 198, 249, 300 108 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 EEPROM Map (continued) Byte # Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 OUT_4_DIV[0] CH_5_MUX[1] CH_5_MUX[0] OUT_5_SEL[1] OUT_5_SEL[0] OUT_5_MODE1[1] OUT_5_MODE1[0] 47, 98, OUT_5_MODE2[1] OUT_5_MODE2[0] 149, 200, 251, 302 OUT_5_DIV[7] OUT_5_DIV[6] OUT_5_DIV[5] OUT_5_DIV[4] OUT_5_DIV[3] OUT_5_DIV[2] 48, 99, OUT_5_DIV[1] 150, 201, 252, 303 CH_6_MUX[1] CH_6_MUX[0] OUT_6_SEL[1] OUT_6_SEL[0] OUT_6_MODE1[1] OUT_6_MODE1[0] 49, 100, OUT_6_MODE2[1] OUT_6_MODE2[0] 151, 202, 253, 304 OUT_6_DIV[7] OUT_6_DIV[6] OUT_6_DIV[5] OUT_6_DIV[4] OUT_6_DIV[3] OUT_6_DIV[2] 50, 101, OUT_6_DIV[1] 152, 203, 254, 305 CH_7_MUX[1] CH_7_MUX[0] OUT_7_SEL[1] OUT_7_SEL[0] OUT_7_MODE1[1] OUT_7_MODE1[0] 51, 102, OUT_7_MODE2[1] OUT_7_MODE2[0] 153, 204, 255, 306 OUT_7_DIV[7] OUT_7_DIV[6] OUT_7_DIV[5] OUT_7_DIV[4] OUT_7_DIV[3] OUT_7_DIV[2] 52, 103, OUT_7_DIV[1] 154, 205, 256, 307 OUT_7_DIV[0] RSRVD RSRVD PLLCMOSPREDIV[1 PLLCMOSPREDIV[0 STATUS1MUX[1] ] ] STATUS1MUX[0] 53, 104, STATUS0MUX[1] 155, 206, 257, 308 STATUS0MUX[0] CMOSDIV0[7] CMOSDIV0[6] CMOSDIV0[5] CMOSDIV0[4] CMOSDIV0[3] CMOSDIV0[2] 54, 105, CMOSDIV0[1] 156, 207, 258, 309 CMOSDIV0[0] RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 55, 106, RSRVD 157, 208, 259, 310 RSRVD CH_7_PREDRVR CH_6_PREDRVR CH_5_PREDRVR CH_4_PREDRVR CH_3_PREDRVR CH_2_PREDRVR 56, 107, CH_1_PREDRVR 158, 209, 260, 311 CH_0_PREDRVR STATUS1SLEW[1] STATUS1SLEW[0] STATUS0SLEW[1] STATUS0SLEW[0] SECBUFSEL[1] SECBUFSEL[0] 57, 108, PRIBUFSEL[1] 159, 210, 261, 312 PRIBUFSEL[0] RSRVD RSRVD INSEL_PLL[1] INSEL_PLL[0] CLKMUX_BYPASS RSRVD 58, 109, RSRVD 160, 211, 262, 313 RSRVD RSRVD SECBUFGAIN PRIBUFGAIN PLLRDIV[2] PLLRDIV[1] PLLRDIV[0] 59, 110, PLLMDIV[4] 161, 212, 263, 314 PLLMDIV[3] PLLMDIV[2] PLLMDIV[1] PLLMDIV[0] RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 46, 97, OUT_4_DIV[1] 148, 199, 250, 301 OUT_5_DIV[0] OUT_6_DIV[0] Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 109 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com EEPROM Map (continued) Byte # Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 60, 111, RSRVD 162, 213, 264, 315 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD PLL_P[2] PLL_P[1] PLL_P[0] 61, 112, PLL_SYNC_EN 163, 214, 265, 316 PLL_PDN RSRVD PRI_D PLL_CP[3] PLL_CP[2] PLL_CP[1] PLL_CP[0] 62, 113, PLL_NDIV[11] 164, 215, 266, 317 PLL_NDIV[10] PLL_NDIV[9] PLL_NDIV[8] PLL_NDIV[7] PLL_NDIV[6] PLL_NDIV[5] PLL_NDIV[4] 63, 114, PLL_NDIV[3] 165, 216, 267, 318 PLL_NDIV[2] PLL_NDIV[1] PLL_NDIV[0] PLL_NUM[21] PLL_NUM[20] PLL_NUM[19] PLL_NUM[18] 64, 115, PLL_NUM[17] 166, 217, 268, 319 PLL_NUM[16] PLL_NUM[15] PLL_NUM[14] PLL_NUM[13] PLL_NUM[12] PLL_NUM[11] PLL_NUM[10] 65, 116, PLL_NUM[9] 167, 218, 269, 320 PLL_NUM[8] PLL_NUM[7] PLL_NUM[6] PLL_NUM[5] PLL_NUM[4] PLL_NUM[3] PLL_NUM[2] 66, 117, PLL_NUM[1] 168, 219, 270, 321 PLL_NUM[0] PLL_DEN[21] PLL_DEN[20] PLL_DEN[19] PLL_DEN[18] PLL_DEN[17] PLL_DEN[16] 67, 118, PLL_DEN[15] 169, 220, 271, 322 PLL_DEN[14] PLL_DEN[13] PLL_DEN[12] PLL_DEN[11] PLL_DEN[10] PLL_DEN[9] PLL_DEN[8] 68, 119, PLL_DEN[7] 170, 221, 272, 323 PLL_DEN[6] PLL_DEN[5] PLL_DEN[4] PLL_DEN[3] PLL_DEN[2] PLL_DEN[1] PLL_DEN[0] 69, 120, PLL_DTHRMODE[ 171, 222, 1] 273, 324 PLL_DTHRMODE[0] PLL_ORDER[1] PLL_ORDER[0] PLL_LF_R2[5] PLL_LF_R2[4] PLL_LF_R2[3] PLL_LF_R2[2] 70, 121, PLL_LF_R2[1] 172, 223, 274, 325 PLL_LF_R2[0] PLL_LF_C1[2] PLL_LF_C1[1] PLL_LF_C1[0] PLL_LF_R3[6] PLL_LF_R3[5] PLL_LF_R3[4] 71, 122, PLL_LF_R3[3] 173, 224, 275, 326 PLL_LF_R3[2] PLL_LF_R3[1] PLL_LF_R3[0] PLL_LF_C3[2] PLL_LF_C3[1] PLL_LF_C3[0] RSRVD 72, 123, RSRVD 174, 225, 276, 327 RSRVD RSRVD 1 RSRVD SEC_D RSRVD RSRVD 73, 124, RSRVD 175, 226, 277, 328 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 110 Bit7 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 EEPROM Map (continued) Byte # Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 74, 125, RSRVD 176, 227, 278, 329 Bit7 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 75, 126, RSRVD 177, 228, 279, 330 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 76, 127, RSRVD 178, 229, 280, 331 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 77, 128, RSRVD 179, 230, 281, 332 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 78, 129, RSRVD 180, 231, 282, 333 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 79, 130, RSRVD 181, 232, 283, 334 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 80, 131, RSRVD 182, 233, 284, 335 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 81, 132, RSRVD 183, 234, 285, 336 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 82, 133, RSRVD 184, 235, 286, 337 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD 83, 134, RSRVD 185, 236, 287, 338 MARGIN_OPTION[1] MARGIN_OPTION[0] STAT0_SEL[3] STAT0_SEL[2] STAT0_SEL[1] STAT0_SEL[0] STAT0_POL 84, 135, STAT1_SEL[3] 186, 237, 288, 339 STAT1_SEL[2] STAT1_SEL[1] STAT1_SEL[0] STAT1_POL DETECT_BYP TERM2GND_SEC TERM2GND_PRI 85, 136, DIFFTERM_SEC 187, 238, 289, 340 DIFFTERM_PRI AC_MODE_SEC AC_MODE_PRI CMOSCHPWDN CH7PWDN CH6PWDN CH5PWDN 86, 137, CH4PWDN 188, 239, 290, 341 CH23PWDN CH01PWDN PLL_STRETCH PLL_DISABLE_4TH[ PLL_DISABLE_4TH[ PLL_DISABLE_4TH[ PLL_CLSDWAIT[1] 2] 1] 0] PLL_VCOWAIT[0] PLL_LOOPBW RSRVD 87, 138, PLL_CLSDWAIT[0] PLL_VCOWAIT[1] 189, 240, 291, 342 RSRVD 1 1 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 111 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com EEPROM Map (continued) Byte # Bit7 88, 139, RSRVD 190, 241, 292, 343 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD RSRVD XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP 9] 8] 4[7] Bit1 Bit0 89, 140, XOOFFSET_STEP XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP4[ XOOFFSET_STEP4[ SECONSWITCH 191, 242, 4[6] 5] 4] 3] 2] 1] 0] 293, 344 112 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 11 Application and Implementation NOTE Information in the following applications sections is not part of the TI component specification, and TI does not warrant its accuracy or completeness. TI’s customers are responsible for determining suitability of components for their purposes. Customers should validate and test their design implementation to confirm system functionality. 11.1 Application Information The LMK03318 is an ultra-low jitter clock generator that can be used to provide reference clocks for high-speed serial links resulting in improved system performance. The LMK03318 also supports a variety of features that aids the hardware designer during the system debug and validation phase. 11.2 Typical Applications 11.2.1 Application Block Diagram Examples 25 MHz (buffered) CPLD Low-jitter PHY ref clocks 25-MHz crystal Osc PLL 5 GHz CLK Dist. 156.25 MHz 10G PHY 125 MHz 1G PHY 100 MHz PCIe 33 MHz CPU/ NPU Up to ±50 ppm frequency margining with pullable crystal Figure 76. 10 Gb Ethernet Switch/Router Line Card Low-jitter PHY ref clocks 156.25 MHz (4x) 25-MHz crystal Osc PLL 5 GHz CLK Dist. Up to ±50 ppm frequency margining with pullable crystal 25 MHz 33 MHz 10G PHY CPLD CPU Figure 77. 10-Gb Ethernet Switch Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 113 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Typical Applications (continued) 25 MHz 25-MHz crystal Osc PLL (Frac) 5.3125 GHz 156.25 MHz (2x) 10G 10G PHY PHY 106.25 MHz (2x) 8G 8G FC FC 132.8125 MHz (2x) 16G 16G FC FC CLK Dist. Up to ±50 ppm frequency margining with pullable crystal CPLD Low-jitter PHY ref clocks Figure 78. Storage Area Network With Fibre Channel Over Ethernet (FCoE) Low-jitter PHY ref clocks 19.44-MHz Backplane From DPLL PLL 4.97664 GHz CLK Dist. 155.52 MHz (4x) STM64 Figure 79. SDH Line Card 11.2.2 Jitter Considerations in Serdes Systems Jitter-sensitive applications such as 10 Gbps or 100 Gbps Ethernet, deploy a serial link utilizing a Serializer in the transmit section (TX) and a De-serializer in the receive section (RX). These SERDES blocks are typically embedded in an ASIC or FPGA. Estimating the clock jitter impact on the link budget requires understanding of the TX PLL bandwidth and the RX CDR bandwidth. As can be seen in Figure 80, the pass band region between the TX low pass cutoff and RX high pass cutoff frequencies is the range over which the reference clock jitter adds without any attenuation to the jitter budget of the link. Outside of these frequencies, the SERDES link will attenuate the reference clock jitter with a 20 dB/dec or even steeper roll-off. Modern ASIC or FPGA designs have some flexibility on deciding the optimal RX CDR bandwidth and TX PLL bandwidth. These bandwidths are typically set based on what is achievable in the ASIC or FPGA process node, without increasing design complexity, and on any jitter tolerance or wander specification that needs to be met, as related to the RX CDR bandwidth. The overall allowable jitter in a serial link is dictated by IEEE or other relevant standards. For example, IEEE802.3ba states that the maximum transmit jitter (peak-peak) for 10 Gbps Ethernet should be no more than 0.28 * UI and this equates to a 27.1516 ps, p-p for the overall allowable transmit jitter. The jitter contributing elements are made up of the reference clock, generated potentially from a device like LMK03318, the transmit medium, transmit driver etc. Only a portion of the overall allowable transmit jitter is allocated to the reference clock, typically 20% or lower. Therefore, the allowable reference clock jitter, for a 20% clock jitter budget, is 5.43 ps, p-p. Jitter in a reference clock is made up of deterministic jitter (arising from spurious signals due to supply noise or mixing from other outputs or from the reference input) and random jitter (usually due to thermal noise and other uncorrelated noise sources). A typical clock tree in a serial link system consists of clock generators and fanout buffers. The allowable reference clock jitter of 5.43 ps, p-p is needed at the output of the fanout buffer. Modern fanout buffers have low additive random jitter (less than 100 fs, rms) with no substantial contribution to the deterministic jitter. Therefore, the clock generator and fanout buffer contribute to the random jitter while the primary contributor to the deterministic jitter is the clock generator. Rule of thumb, for modern clock generators, is to allocate 25% of allowable reference clock jitter to the deterministic jitter and 75% to the random jitter. This 114 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Typical Applications (continued) amounts to an allowable deterministic jitter of 1.36 ps, p-p and an allowable random jitter of 4.07 ps, p-p. For serial link systems that need to meet a BER of 10–12, the allowable random jitter in root-mean-square is 0.29 ps, rms. This is calculated by dividing the p-p jitter by 14 for a BER of 10–12. Accounting for random jitter from the fanout buffer, the random jitter needed from the clock generator is 0.27 ps, rms. This is calculated by the rootmean-square subtraction from the desired jitter at the fanout buffer's output assuming 100 fs, rms of additive jitter from the fanout buffer. With careful frequency planning techniques, like spur optimization (covered in the Spur Mitigation Techniques section) and on-chip LDOs to suppress supply noise, the LMK03318 is able to generate clock outputs with deterministic jitter that is below 1 ps, p-p and random jitter that is below 0.2 ps, rms. This gives the serial link system with additional margin on the allowable transmit jitter resulting in a BER better than 10–12. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 115 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Typical Applications (continued) TX Parallel Data RX Serializer Parallel Data Sampler Serialized clock/data Recovered Clock TX PLL CDR Deserializer Ref Clk HRXCDR(f) F1 = TX_PLL_BWmax Jitter Transfer (on clock) HRXCDR(f) Jitter Tolerance (on data) HTXPLL(f) Jitter Transfer (on clock) F2 = RX_CDR_BWmin F2 = RX_CDR_BWmin H(f) Jitter Tolerance (on data) F2 SoC trend: Increase stop band Less % of jitter budget H(f) Jitter Transfer (on clock) F2 F1 SoC trend: Decrease stop band Improved LO design Figure 80. Dependence of Clock Jitter in Serial Links 116 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Typical Applications (continued) 11.2.3 Frequency Margining 11.2.3.1 Fine Frequency Margining IEEE802.3 dictates that Ethernet frames stay compliant to the standard specifications when clocked with a reference clock that is within ±100 ppm of its nominal frequency. In the worst case, an RX node with its local reference clock at –100 ppm from its nominal frequency should be able to work seamlessly with a TX node that has its own local reference clock at +100 ppm from its nominal frequency. Without any clock compensation on the RX node, the read pointer will severely lag behind the write pointer and cause FIFO overflow errors. On the contrary, when the RX node’s local clock operates at 100 ppm from its nominal frequency and the TX node’s local clock operates at –100 ppm from its nominal frequency, FIFO underflow errors occur without any clock compensation. In order to prevent such overflow and underflow errors from occuring, modern ASICs and FGPAs include a clock compensation scheme that introduces elastic buffers. Such a system, shown in Figure 80, is validated thoroughly during the validation phase by interfacing slower nodes with faster ones and ensuring compliance to IEEE802.3. The LMK03318 provides the ability to fine tune the frequency of its outputs based on changing its on-chip load capacitance when operated with a crystal input. This fine tuning can be done via I2C or via the GPIO5 pin as described in Crystal Input Interface (SEC_REF). A total of ±50 ppm frequency tuning is achievable when using pullable crystals whose C0/C1 ratio is less than 250. The change in load capacitance is implemented in a manner such that the outputs of the LMK03318 undergo a smooth monotic change in frequency. TX RX Serializer Post Processing w/ clock compensation Sampler Serialized clock/data Parallel Data Recovered Clock Parallel Data +/- 100 ppm TX PLL CDR Ref Clk +/- 100 ppm Ref Clk Deserializer Elastic Buffer (clock compensation) FIFO circular Latency Write Pointer Read Pointer Figure 81. System Implementation with Clock Compensation for Standards Compliance 11.2.3.2 Coarse Frequency Margining Certain systems require the processors to be tested at clock frequencies that are slower or faster by 5% or 10%. The LMK03318 offers the ability to change its output dividers for the desired change from its nominal output frequency without resulting in any glitches (as explained in High-Speed Output Divider). Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 117 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Typical Applications (continued) 11.2.4 Design Requirements Consider a typical wired communications application, like a top-of-rack switch, which needs to clock high data rate 10 Gbps or 100 Gbps Ethernet PHYs and other macros like PCI Express, Fast Ethernet and CPLD. For such asynchronous systems, the reference input can be a crystal. In such systems, the clocks are expected to be available upon powerup without the need for any device-level programming. An example of clock input and output requirements are shown below: • Clock Input: – 25 MHz crystal • Clock Outputs: – 2x 156.25 MHz clock for uplink 10.3125 Gbps, LVPECL – 2x 125 MHz clock for downlink 3.125 Gbps, LVPECL – 2x 100 MHz clock for PCI Express, HCSL – 1x 25 MHz clock for Fast Ethernet, LVDS – 2x 33.3333 MHz clock for CPLD, 1.8-V LVCMOS The section below describes the detailed design procedure to generate the required output frequencies for the above scenario using LMK03318. 11.2.4.1 Detailed Design Procedure Design of all aspects of the LMK03318 is quite involved, and software support is available to assist in part selection, part programming, loop filter design, and phase-noise simulation. This design procedure will give a quick outline of the process. 1. Device Selection – The first step to calculate the specified VCO frequency given required output frequencies. The device must be able to produce the VCO frequency that can be divided down to the required output frequencies. – The WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool from TI will aid in the selection of the right device that meets the customer's output frequencies and format requirements. 2. Device Configuration – There are many device configurations to achieve the desired output frequencies from a device. However there are some optimizations and trade-offs to be considered. – The WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool attempts to maximize the phase detector frequency, use smallest dividers, and maximizes PLL charge pump current. – These guidelines below may be followed when configuring PLL related dividers or other related registers: – For lowest possible in-band PLL flat noise, maximize phase detector frequency to minimize N divide value. – For lowest possible in-band PLL flat noise, maximize charge pump current. The highest value charge pump currents often have similar performance due to diminishing returns. – To reduce loop filter component sizes, increase N value and/or reduce charge pump current. – For fractional divider values, keep the denominator at highest value possible in order to minimize spurs. It is also best to use higher order modulator wherever possible for the same reason. – As a rule of thumb, keeping the phase detector frequency approximately between 10 * PLL loop bandwidth and 100 * PLL loop bandwidth. A phase detector frequency less than 5 * PLL bandwidth may be unstable and a phase detector frequency > 100 * loop bandwidth may experience increased lock time due to cycle slipping. 3. PLL Loop Filter Design – It is recommended to use the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool to design your loop filter. – Optimal loop filter design and simulation can be achieved when custom reference phase noise profiles are loaded into the software tool. – While designing the loop filter, adjusting the charge pump current or N value can help with loop filter component selection. Lower charge pump currents and larger N values result in smaller component values but may increase impacts of leakage and reduce PLL phase noise performance. – For a more detailed understanding of loop filter design can be found in Dean Banerjee's PLL 118 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Typical Applications (continued) Performance, Simulation, and Design (www.ti.com/tool/pll_book). 4. Clock Output Assignment – At the time of writing this datasheet, the design software does not take into account frequency assignment to specific outputs except to ensure that the output frequencies can be achieved. It is best to consider proximity of the clock outputs to each other and other PLL circuitry when choosing final clock output locations. Here are some guidelines to help achieve optimal performance when assigning outputs to specific clock output pins. – Group common frequencies together. – PLL charge pump circuitry can cause crosstalk at the charge pump frequency. Place outputs sharing charge pump frequency or lower priority outputs not sensitive to charge pump frequency spurs together. – Clock output MUXes can create a path for noise coupling. Factor in frequencies which may have some bleedthrough from non-selected mux inputs. – If possible, use outputs 0, 1, 2 or 3 since they don’t have MUX in the clock path and have limited opportunity for cross coupled noise. 5. Device Programming – The EVM programming software tool CodeLoader can be used to program the device with the desired configuration. 11.2.4.1.1 Device Selection Use the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool. Enter the required frequencies and formats into the tool. To use this device, find a solution using the LMK03318. 11.2.4.1.1.1 Calculation Using LCM In this example, the LCM (156.25 MHz, 125 MHz, 100 MHz, 33.3333 MHz, 25 MHz) = 2500 MHz. Valid VCO frequency for LMK03318 is 5 GHz (2500 × 2). 11.2.4.1.2 Device Configuration For this example, when using the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool, the reference would have been manually entered as 25 MHz according to input frequency requirements. Enter the desired output frequencies and click on 'Generate Solutions'. Select LMK03318 from the solution list. From the simulation page of the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool, it can be seen that to maximize phase detector frequencies, the PLL's R and M dividers are set to 1, doublers are disabled and N divider is set to 200. This results in a VCO frequency of 5 GHz. The tool also tries to select maximum possible value for the PLL post divider and for this example, it is set to 2. At this point the design meets all input and output frequency requirements and it is possible to design a loop filter for system and simulate performance on the clock outputs. However, consider also the following: • At the time of release of this datasheet, the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool doesn't assign outputs strategically for minimizing cross-coupled spurs and jitter. 11.2.4.1.3 PLL Loop Filter Design The WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool allows loading a custom phase noise plot for reference inputs. For improved accuracy in simulation and optimum loop filter design, be sure to load these custom noise profiles. After loading a phase noise plot, user should recalculate the recommended loop filter design. The WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool will return solutions with high reference/phase detector frequencies by default. In the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool the user may increase the reference divider to reduce the frequency if desired. The next section will discuss PLL loop filter design specific to this example using default phase noise profiles. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 119 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Typical Applications (continued) NOTE The WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool provides optimal loop filters upon selecting a solution from the solution list to simulate for the first time. Anytime PLL related inputs change, like input phase noise, charge pump current, divider values, and so forth, it is best to use the tool to re-calculate the optimal loop filter component values. 11.2.4.1.3.1 PLL Loop Filter Design In the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool simulator, click on the PLL loop filter design button, then press recommend design. For the PLL loop filter, maximum phase detector frequency and maximum charge pump current are typically used. The tool recommends a loop filter that is designed to minimize jitter. The integrated loop filters’ components are minimized with this recommendation as to allow maximum flexibility in achieving wide loop bandwidths for low PLL noise. With the recommended loop filter calculated, this loop filter is ready to be simulated. The PLL loop filter’s bode plot can additionally be viewed and adjustments can be made to the integrated components. The effective loop bandwidth and phase margin with the updated values is then calculated. The integrated loop filter components are good to use when attempting to eliminate certain spurs. The recommended procedure is to increase C3 capacitance, then R3 resistance. Large R3 resistance can result in degraded VCO phase noise performance. 11.2.4.1.4 Clock Output Assignment At this time the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool does not assign output frequencies to specific output ports on the device with the intention to minimize cross-coupled spurs and jitter. The user may wish to make some educated re-assignment of outputs when using the EVM programming tool to configure the device registers appropriately. In an effort to optimize device configuration for best jitter performance, following guidelines should be considered: • Since the clock outputs, intended to be used to clock high data rates, are needed with lowest possible jitter, it is best to assign 156.25 MHz to outputs 0, 1 and assign 125 MHz to outputs 2, 3. • Coupling between outputs at different frequencies appear as spurs at offsets that is at the frequency difference between the outputs and its harmonics. Typical SerDes reference clocks need to have low integrated jitter upto an offset of 20 MHz and thus, to minimize cross coupling between output 3 and output 4, it is best to assign 100 MHz to outputs 4 and 5. • The 25 MHz can then be assigned to output 6. • The 1.8-V LVCMOS clock at 33.3333 MHz is assigned to output 7 and it is best to select complementary LVCMOS operation. This helps to minimize coupling from this output channel to other outputs. 11.2.4.2 Spur Mitigation Techniques The LMK03318 offers several programmable features for optimizing fractional spurs. In order to get the best out of these features, it makes sense to understand the different kinds of spurs as well as their behaviors, causes, and remedies. Although optimizing spurs may involve some trial and error, there are ways to make this process more systematic. 11.2.4.2.1 Phase Detector Spurs The phase detector spur occurs at an offset from the carrier equal to the phase detector frequency, fPD. To minimize this spur, a lower phase detector frequency should be considered. In some cases where the loop bandwidth is very wide relative to the phase detector frequency, some benefit might be gained from using a narrower loop bandwidth or adding poles to the loop filter by using R3 and C3 if previously unused, but otherwise the loop filter has minimal impact. Bypassing at the supply pins and board layout can also have an impact on this spur, especially at higher phase detector frequencies. 120 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Typical Applications (continued) 11.2.4.2.2 Integer Boundary Fractional Spurs This spur occurs at an offset equal to the difference between the VCO frequency and the closest integer channel for the VCO. For instance, if the phase detector frequency is 100 MHz and the VCO frequency is 5003 MHz, then the integer boundary spur would be at 3 MHz offset. This spur can be either PLL or VCO dominated. If it is PLL dominated, decreasing the loop bandwidth and some of the programmable fractional words may impact this spur. If the spur is VCO dominated, then reducing the loop filter will not help, but rather reducing the phase detector and having good slew rate and signal integrity at the selected reference input will help. 11.2.4.2.3 Primary Fractional Spurs These spurs occur at multiples of fPD/DEN and are not integer boundary spurs. For instance, if the phase detector frequency is 100 MHz and the fraction is 3/100, the primary fractional spurs would be at 1 MHz, 2 MHz, 4 MHz, 5 MHz, 6 MHz etc. These are impacted by the loop filter bandwidth and modulator order. If a small frequency error is acceptable, then a larger equivalent fraction may improve these spurs. This larger unequivalent fraction pushes the fractional spur energy to much lower frequencies where they do not significantly impact the system peformance. 11.2.4.2.4 Sub-Fractional Spurs These spurs appear at a fraction of fPD/DEN and depend on modulator order. With the first order modulator, there are no sub-fractional spurs. The second order modulator can produce 1/2 sub-fractional spurs if the denominator is even. A third order modulator can produce sub-fractional spurs at 1/2, 1/3, or 1/6 of the offset, depending if it is divisible by 2 or 3. For instance, if the phase detector frequency is 100 MHz and the fraction is 3/100, no subfractional spurs for a first order modulator or sub-fractional spurs at multiples of 1.5 MHz for a second or third order modulator would be expected. Aside from strategically choosing the fractional denominator and using a lower order modulator, another tactic to eliminate these spurs is to use dithering and express the fraction in larger equivalent terms. Since dithering also adds phase noise, its level needs to be managed to achieve acceptable phase noise and spurious performance. Table 19 gives a summary of the spurs discussed so far and techniques to mitigate them. Table 19. Spurs and Mitigation Techniques SPUR TYPE OFFSET Phase Detector fPD Integer Boundary fVCO mod fPD WAYS TO REDUCE TRADE-OFFS Reduce Phase Detector Frequency. Although reducing the phase detector frequency does improve this spur, it also degrades phase noise. Methods for PLL Dominated Spurs -Avoid the worst case VCO frequencies if possible. -Ensure good slew rate and signal integrity at reference input. -Reduce loop bandwidth or add more filter poles to suppress out of band spurs. Reducing the loop bandwidth may degrade the total integrated noise if the bandwidth is too narrow. Methods for VCO Dominated Reducing the phase detector Spurs may degrade the phase noise. -Avoid the worst case VCO frequencies if possible. -Reduce Phase Detector Frequency. -Ensure good slew rate and signal integrity at reference input. Primary Fractional fPD/DEN -Decrease Loop Bandwidth. -Change Modulator Order. use Larger Unequivalent Fractions. Decreasing the loop bandwidth may degrade in-band phase noise. Also, larger unequivalent fractions don’t always reduce spurs. Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 121 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Typical Applications (continued) Table 19. Spurs and Mitigation Techniques (continued) 122 SPUR TYPE OFFSET WAYS TO REDUCE Sub-Fractional fPD/DEN/k k=2,3, or 6 use Dithering. use Larger Equivalent Fractions. use Larger Unequivalent Fractions. -Reduce Modulator Order. -Eliminate factors of 2 or 3 in denominator. Submit Documentation Feedback TRADE-OFFS Dithering and larger fractions may increase phase noise. Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 12 Power Supply Recommendations 12.1 Device Power Up Sequence Figure 82 shows the power up sequence of the LMK03318 in both the hard pin mode and soft pin mode. Power on Reset tnot PDN = 1? (all outputs are disabled) HW_SW_CTRL 1 0 Hard Pin Mode (activate I2C IF) Soft Pin Mode (activate I2C IF) Latch GPIO[5:0] to select 1 of 64 device settings from ROM codes Latch GPIO[3:1] to select 1 of 6 device settings from EEPROM Registers programmable via I2C. Latch GPIO1 for LSB of I2C address. Enter pin mode specified by GPIO Configure all device settings wait for selected reference input signal (PRI/SEC) to become valid wait for selected reference input signal (PRI/SEC) to become valid Disable outputs Calibrate VCO Auto-synchronize outputs Mute outputs till PLL locks and outputs are synchronized Enable outputs Clear R12.6, R56.1 (default enabled) Disable outputs Calibrate VCO Auto-synchronize outputs Mute outputs till PLL locks and outputs are synchronized Enable outputs Normal device operation in Hard Pin Mode. Host can reprogram device via I2C. tnot yes GPIO0 pin or R12.6 = 1? PDN = 1? yes Synchronize outputs while outputs are muted Enable all outputs Clear R12.6, R56.1 Normal device operation in Soft Pin Mode. Host can reprogram device via I2C and can be written to on-chip EEPROM. yes Disable all outputs no GPIO0 pin or R12.6 = 1? yes PDN = 1? no Disable all outputs Figure 82. Flow Chart for Device Power Up and Configuration Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 123 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 12.2 Device Power Up Timing Before the outputs are enabled after power up, the LMK03318 goes through the initialization routine given in Table 20. Table 20. LMK03318 Power Up Initialization Routine Parameter TPWR Duration Comments Depends on customer supply ramp time The POR monitor holds the device in powerdown/reset until the core supply voltages reaches 2.72 V (min) to 2.95 V (max) and VDDO_01 reaches 1.7 V (min). Step 2: XO startup (if crystal is used) Depends on XTAL. Could be several ms; For TXC 25 MHz typical XTAL startup time measures 100 us. This step assumes PDN=1. The XTAL startup time is the time it takes for the XTAL to oscillate with sufficient amplitude. The LMK03318 has a built-in amplitude detection circuit, and halts the PLL lock sequence until the XTAL stage has sufficient swing. TCAL-PLL Step 3: Closed loop calibration period for PLL Programmable cycles of internal 10 MHz oscillator. This counter is needed for the PLL loop to stabilize. It can also be used to provide additional delay time for the selected PLL reference input to stabilize, in case the reference detection circuit validates the input too soon. The duration can range from 30 us to 300 ms and programmed in R119[3-2]. Recommended duration for PLL as clock generator (loop bandwidth > 10 kHz) is 300 us and for PLL as jitter cleaner (loop bandwidth < 1 kHz) is 300 ms. TVCO Step 4: VCO wait period Programmable cycles of internal 10 MHz oscillator. This counter is needed for the VCO to stabilize. The duration can range from 20 us to 200 ms and programmed in R119[1-0]. Recommended duration for VCO1 is 400 us. Step 5: PLL lock time ~4/LBW of PLL The Outputs turn on immediately after calibration. A small frequency error remains for the duration of ~4/LBW (so in clock generator mode typically 10 us for a PLL bandwidth of 400 kHz). The initial output frequency will be lower than the target output frequency, as the loop filter starts out initially discharged. Step 6: PLL LOL indicator low ~1 PFD clock cycle The PLL loss of lock indicator if selected on STATUS0 or STATUS1 will go low after 1 PFD clock cycle to indicate PLL is now locked. TXO TLOCK-PLL TLOL-PLL 124 Definition Step 1: Power up ramp Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 The LMK03318 start-up time for the PLL is defined as the time taken, from the moment the core supplies reach 2.72 V and VDDO_01 reaches 1.7 V, for the PLL to be locked and valid outputs are available at the outputs with no more than +/- 300 ppm error. Startup time for the PLL can be calculated as TPLL-SU = TXO + TCAL-PLL + TVCO + TLOCK-PLL (5) 12.3 Power Down The PDN pin (active low) can be used both as device power-down pin and to initialize the device. When this pin is pulled low, the entire device is powered down. When it is pulled high, the power-on/reset (POR) sequence is triggered and causes all registers to be set to an initial state. The initial state is determined by the device control pins as described in the Device Configuration Control section. When PDN is pulled low, I2C is disabled. When PDN is pulled high, the device power-up sequence is initiated as described in Device Power Up Sequence and Device Power Up Timing. Table 21. PDN Control PDN Pin State Device operation 0 Device is disabled 1 Normal operation 12.4 Power Rail Sequencing, Power Supply Ramp Rate, and Mixing Supply Domains 12.4.1 Mixing Supplies The LMK03318 incorporates flexible power supply architecture. While the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO and VDD_DIG supplies have to be driven by the same 3.3 V supply rail, the individual VDDO_x supplies can be driven from separate 1.8 V, 2.5 V or 3.3 V supply rails. Lowest power consumption can be realized by operating the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO and VDD_DIG supplies from a 3.3 V rail and the VDDO_x supplies from a 1.8 V rail. 12.4.2 Power-On Reset The LMK03318 integrates a built-in POR circuit, that holds the device in reset until: a) the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, and VDD_DIG supplies have reached at least 2.72 V, and b) the VDDO_01 supply has reach at least 1.7 V. After this power-on release, device internal counters start (see Device Power Up Timing) followed by device calibration. While the device digital circuit resets properly at this supply voltage level, the device's analog core supplies are not sufficiently high enough to ensure proper calibration until these supplies have settled within their respective operating voltage tolerances of ±5%. For very slow and non-uniform power-up ramps, it would be necessary to delay calibration further using the PDN input. 12.4.3 Slow and Non-Uniform Power-Up Supply Ramp In case the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, and VDD_DIG, and VDDO_01 supplies ramp slowly and in a nonuniform non-monotonic manner, it is recommended to start the PLL calibration until after the supplies have settled within their respective operating voltage tolerances of ±5%. This can be realized by delaying the PDN low-to-high transition. The PDN input incorporates a 200 kΩ resistor to VDDO_01. Assuming the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO and VDD_DIG supplies are derived from a single 3.3 V supply rail and VDDO_01 is derived from a separate 1.8 V rail which is ramped later (ie.g. violating the 100 ms maximum supply ramp time), then a capacitor from the PDN pin to GND can be used to form a R-C time constant with the internal 200 kΩ pullup resistor. This R-C time constant can be designed to delay the low-to-high transition of PDN, in the case of all supplies ramping in a non-monotonic and non-uniform manner and has settled within their respective voltage tolerances. If however the VDDO_01 supply ramps much sooner than the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO and VDD_DIG supplies, additional means are necessary to prevent PDN from toggling too early. A premature release of PDN would possibly result in failed PLL calibration, which can only be corrected by re-calibrating the PLL by either toggling PDN or programming the software reset (R12.7). Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 125 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Power Rail Sequencing, Power Supply Ramp Rate, and Mixing Supply Domains (continued) VDDO_01 1.7 V (VDDO_01) 200 k 0V PDN 3.135 V (VDD_DIG, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, VDD_PRI, VDD_SEC) 2.72 V VDVDD W•0 CPDN VDDO_01 LMK03318 VIH(min) 0V VPDN Figure 83. PDN Delay when Using Slow and Non-Uniform Ramping Power Supplies 12.4.4 Fast Power-Up Supply Ramp If the VDD_IN, VDD_PLL, VDD_LDO, and VDD_DIG, and VDDO_01 supplies ramp within their respective operating voltage tolerances of ±5% in less than 100 ms, then there is no requirement to add a capacitor on the PDN pin to externally delay the device power-up sequence. The PDN pin can be left floating, or otherwise driven by a host controller for meeting the clock sequencing requirements in the system, for example. 12.4.5 Slow Reference Input Clock Startup If the reference input clock is direct coupled to the LMK03318 and has a very slow startup time, over 10 ms, additional care needs to be taken to prevent unsuccessful PLL calibration. In the case of the reference input building up its amplitude slowly, it is recommended to set the input buffer to differential irrespective of the input type (LVCMOS or differential). In case of LVCMOS inputs, it is also recommended to enable on-chip termination by setting R29.4 (for primary input) and/or R29.5 (for secondary input) to 1. There is one of two additional steps that need to be taken. The first approach is to add a capacitor to GND on the PDN pin that forms a R-C time constant with the internal 200 kΩ pullup resistor. This R-C time constant can be designed to delay the low-to-high transition of PDN, until after the reference input clock is stable. The second approach is to program a larger PLL closed loop delay in R119[3-2] that is longer than the time taken for the reference input clock to be stable. 12.5 Power Supply Bypassing Figure 84 shows two conceptual layouts detailing recommended placement of power supply bypass capacitors. If the capacitors are mounted on the back side, 0402 components can be employed; however, soldering to the Thermal Dissipation Pad can be difficult. For component side mounting, use 0201 body size capacitors to facilitate signal routing. Keep the connections between the bypass capacitors and the power supply on the device as short as possible. Ground the other side of the capacitor using a low impedance connection to the ground plane. 126 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Power Supply Bypassing (continued) Figure 84. Conceptual Placement of Power Supply Bypass Capacitors (NOT Representative of LMK03318 Supply Pin Locations) Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 127 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 13 Layout 13.1 Layout Guidelines The following section provides the layout guidelines to ensure good thermal and electrical performance for the LMK03318. 13.1.1 Ensure Thermal Reliability The LMK03318 is a high performance device. Therefore, careful attention must be paid to device configuration and printed circuit board (PCB) layout with respect to device power consumption and thermal considerations. Employing a thermally-enhanced PCB layout can insure good thermal dissipation from the device to the PCB layers. Observing good thermal layout practices enables the thermal slug, or die attach pad (DAP), on the bottom of the QFN-48 package to provide a good thermal path between the die contained within the package and the ambient air through the PCB interface. This thermal pad also serves as the singular ground connection the device; therefore, a low-inductance connection to multiple PCB ground layers (both internal and external) is essential. 13.1.2 Layout Example Figure 85 shows a PCB layout example showing the application of thermal design practices and low-inductance ground connection between the device DAP and the PCB. Connecting a 6 x 6 thermal via pattern and using multiple PCB ground layers (for example, 8- or 10-layer PCB) can help to reduce the junction-to-ambient thermal resistance, as indicated in the Thermal Information section. The 6 × 6 filled via pattern facilitates both considerations. 128 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 LMK03318 www.ti.com SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 Layout Guidelines (continued) Figure 85. 4-Layer PCB Thermal Layout Example for LMK03318 (8+ Layers Recommended) Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 129 LMK03318 SNAS669A – SEPTEMBER 2015 – REVISED DECEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 14 Device and Documentation Support 14.1 Device Support 14.1.1 Third-Party Products Disclaimer TI'S PUBLICATION OF INFORMATION REGARDING THIRD-PARTY PRODUCTS OR SERVICES DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN ENDORSEMENT REGARDING THE SUITABILITY OF SUCH PRODUCTS OR SERVICES OR A WARRANTY, REPRESENTATION OR ENDORSEMENT OF SUCH PRODUCTS OR SERVICES, EITHER ALONE OR IN COMBINATION WITH ANY TI PRODUCT OR SERVICE. 14.2 Community Resources The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views; see TI's Terms of Use. TI E2E™ Online Community TI's Engineer-to-Engineer (E2E) Community. Created to foster collaboration among engineers. At e2e.ti.com, you can ask questions, share knowledge, explore ideas and help solve problems with fellow engineers. Design Support TI's Design Support Quickly find helpful E2E forums along with design support tools and contact information for technical support. 14.3 Trademarks E2E is a trademark of Texas Instruments. 14.4 Electrostatic Discharge Caution These devices have limited built-in ESD protection. The leads should be shorted together or the device placed in conductive foam during storage or handling to prevent electrostatic damage to the MOS gates. 14.5 Glossary SLYZ022 — TI Glossary. This glossary lists and explains terms, acronyms, and definitions. 15 Mechanical, Packaging, and Orderable Information The following pages include mechanical, packaging, and orderable information. This information is the most current data available for the designated devices. This data is subject to change without notice and revision of this document. For browser-based versions of this data sheet, refer to the left-hand navigation. 130 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: LMK03318 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 13-Dec-2015 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Pins Package Drawing Qty Eco Plan Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (2) (6) (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) LMK03318RHSR ACTIVE WQFN RHS 48 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 K03318A LMK03318RHST ACTIVE WQFN RHS 48 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 K03318A (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. Addendum-Page 1 Samples PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 13-Dec-2015 In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. Addendum-Page 2 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 14-Dec-2015 TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Package Pins Type Drawing SPQ Reel Reel A0 Diameter Width (mm) (mm) W1 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W Pin1 (mm) Quadrant LMK03318RHSR WQFN RHS 48 2500 330.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.3 12.0 16.0 Q1 LMK03318RHST WQFN RHS 48 250 178.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.3 12.0 16.0 Q1 Pack Materials-Page 1 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 14-Dec-2015 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) LMK03318RHSR WQFN RHS 48 2500 367.0 367.0 38.0 LMK03318RHST WQFN RHS 48 250 213.0 191.0 55.0 Pack Materials-Page 2 MECHANICAL DATA RHS0048B SQA48B (Rev A) www.ti.com IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated